xref: /dpdk/lib/ethdev/rte_ethdev.h (revision 25a2a0dc3de31ca0a6fbc9371cf3dd85dfd74b07)
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: BSD-3-Clause
2  * Copyright(c) 2010-2017 Intel Corporation
3  */
4 
5 #ifndef _RTE_ETHDEV_H_
6 #define _RTE_ETHDEV_H_
7 
8 /**
9  * @file
10  *
11  * RTE Ethernet Device API
12  *
13  * The Ethernet Device API is composed of two parts:
14  *
15  * - The application-oriented Ethernet API that includes functions to setup
16  *   an Ethernet device (configure it, setup its Rx and Tx queues and start it),
17  *   to get its MAC address, the speed and the status of its physical link,
18  *   to receive and to transmit packets, and so on.
19  *
20  * - The driver-oriented Ethernet API that exports functions allowing
21  *   an Ethernet Poll Mode Driver (PMD) to allocate an Ethernet device instance,
22  *   create memzone for HW rings and process registered callbacks, and so on.
23  *   PMDs should include ethdev_driver.h instead of this header.
24  *
25  * By default, all the functions of the Ethernet Device API exported by a PMD
26  * are lock-free functions which assume to not be invoked in parallel on
27  * different logical cores to work on the same target object.  For instance,
28  * the receive function of a PMD cannot be invoked in parallel on two logical
29  * cores to poll the same Rx queue [of the same port]. Of course, this function
30  * can be invoked in parallel by different logical cores on different Rx queues.
31  * It is the responsibility of the upper level application to enforce this rule.
32  *
33  * If needed, parallel accesses by multiple logical cores to shared queues
34  * shall be explicitly protected by dedicated inline lock-aware functions
35  * built on top of their corresponding lock-free functions of the PMD API.
36  *
37  * In all functions of the Ethernet API, the Ethernet device is
38  * designated by an integer >= 0 named the device port identifier.
39  *
40  * At the Ethernet driver level, Ethernet devices are represented by a generic
41  * data structure of type *rte_eth_dev*.
42  *
43  * Ethernet devices are dynamically registered during the PCI probing phase
44  * performed at EAL initialization time.
45  * When an Ethernet device is being probed, an *rte_eth_dev* structure and
46  * a new port identifier are allocated for that device. Then, the eth_dev_init()
47  * function supplied by the Ethernet driver matching the probed PCI
48  * device is invoked to properly initialize the device.
49  *
50  * The role of the device init function consists of resetting the hardware,
51  * checking access to Non-volatile Memory (NVM), reading the MAC address
52  * from NVM etc.
53  *
54  * If the device init operation is successful, the correspondence between
55  * the port identifier assigned to the new device and its associated
56  * *rte_eth_dev* structure is effectively registered.
57  * Otherwise, both the *rte_eth_dev* structure and the port identifier are
58  * freed.
59  *
60  * The functions exported by the application Ethernet API to setup a device
61  * designated by its port identifier must be invoked in the following order:
62  *     - rte_eth_dev_configure()
63  *     - rte_eth_tx_queue_setup()
64  *     - rte_eth_rx_queue_setup()
65  *     - rte_eth_dev_start()
66  *
67  * Then, the network application can invoke, in any order, the functions
68  * exported by the Ethernet API to get the MAC address of a given device, to
69  * get the speed and the status of a device physical link, to receive/transmit
70  * [burst of] packets, and so on.
71  *
72  * If the application wants to change the configuration (i.e. call
73  * rte_eth_dev_configure(), rte_eth_tx_queue_setup(), or
74  * rte_eth_rx_queue_setup()), it must call rte_eth_dev_stop() first to stop the
75  * device and then do the reconfiguration before calling rte_eth_dev_start()
76  * again. The transmit and receive functions should not be invoked when the
77  * device or the queue is stopped.
78  *
79  * Please note that some configuration is not stored between calls to
80  * rte_eth_dev_stop()/rte_eth_dev_start(). The following configuration will
81  * be retained:
82  *
83  *     - MTU
84  *     - flow control settings
85  *     - receive mode configuration (promiscuous mode, all-multicast mode,
86  *       hardware checksum mode, RSS/VMDq settings etc.)
87  *     - VLAN filtering configuration
88  *     - default MAC address
89  *     - MAC addresses supplied to MAC address array
90  *     - flow director filtering mode (but not filtering rules)
91  *     - NIC queue statistics mappings
92  *
93  * The following configuration may be retained or not
94  * depending on the device capabilities:
95  *
96  *     - flow rules
97  *     - flow-related shared objects, e.g. indirect actions
98  *
99  * Any other configuration will not be stored and will need to be re-entered
100  * before a call to rte_eth_dev_start().
101  *
102  * Finally, a network application can close an Ethernet device by invoking the
103  * rte_eth_dev_close() function.
104  *
105  * Each function of the application Ethernet API invokes a specific function
106  * of the PMD that controls the target device designated by its port
107  * identifier.
108  * For this purpose, all device-specific functions of an Ethernet driver are
109  * supplied through a set of pointers contained in a generic structure of type
110  * *eth_dev_ops*.
111  * The address of the *eth_dev_ops* structure is stored in the *rte_eth_dev*
112  * structure by the device init function of the Ethernet driver, which is
113  * invoked during the PCI probing phase, as explained earlier.
114  *
115  * In other words, each function of the Ethernet API simply retrieves the
116  * *rte_eth_dev* structure associated with the device port identifier and
117  * performs an indirect invocation of the corresponding driver function
118  * supplied in the *eth_dev_ops* structure of the *rte_eth_dev* structure.
119  *
120  * For performance reasons, the address of the burst-oriented Rx and Tx
121  * functions of the Ethernet driver are not contained in the *eth_dev_ops*
122  * structure. Instead, they are directly stored at the beginning of the
123  * *rte_eth_dev* structure to avoid an extra indirect memory access during
124  * their invocation.
125  *
126  * RTE Ethernet device drivers do not use interrupts for transmitting or
127  * receiving. Instead, Ethernet drivers export Poll-Mode receive and transmit
128  * functions to applications.
129  * Both receive and transmit functions are packet-burst oriented to minimize
130  * their cost per packet through the following optimizations:
131  *
132  * - Sharing among multiple packets the incompressible cost of the
133  *   invocation of receive/transmit functions.
134  *
135  * - Enabling receive/transmit functions to take advantage of burst-oriented
136  *   hardware features (L1 cache, prefetch instructions, NIC head/tail
137  *   registers) to minimize the number of CPU cycles per packet, for instance,
138  *   by avoiding useless read memory accesses to ring descriptors, or by
139  *   systematically using arrays of pointers that exactly fit L1 cache line
140  *   boundaries and sizes.
141  *
142  * The burst-oriented receive function does not provide any error notification,
143  * to avoid the corresponding overhead. As a hint, the upper-level application
144  * might check the status of the device link once being systematically returned
145  * a 0 value by the receive function of the driver for a given number of tries.
146  */
147 
148 #include <stdint.h>
149 
150 /* Use this macro to check if LRO API is supported */
151 #define RTE_ETHDEV_HAS_LRO_SUPPORT
152 
153 /* Alias RTE_LIBRTE_ETHDEV_DEBUG for backward compatibility. */
154 #ifdef RTE_LIBRTE_ETHDEV_DEBUG
155 #define RTE_ETHDEV_DEBUG_RX
156 #define RTE_ETHDEV_DEBUG_TX
157 #endif
158 
159 #include <rte_cman.h>
160 #include <rte_compat.h>
161 #include <rte_log.h>
162 #include <rte_interrupts.h>
163 #include <rte_dev.h>
164 #include <rte_devargs.h>
165 #include <rte_bitops.h>
166 #include <rte_errno.h>
167 #include <rte_common.h>
168 #include <rte_config.h>
169 #include <rte_power_intrinsics.h>
170 
171 #include "rte_ethdev_trace_fp.h"
172 #include "rte_dev_info.h"
173 
174 extern int rte_eth_dev_logtype;
175 #define RTE_LOGTYPE_ETHDEV rte_eth_dev_logtype
176 
177 #define RTE_ETHDEV_LOG_LINE(level, ...) \
178 	RTE_LOG_LINE(level, ETHDEV, "" __VA_ARGS__)
179 
180 struct rte_mbuf;
181 
182 /**
183  * Initializes a device iterator.
184  *
185  * This iterator allows accessing a list of devices matching some devargs.
186  *
187  * @param iter
188  *   Device iterator handle initialized by the function.
189  *   The fields bus_str and cls_str might be dynamically allocated,
190  *   and could be freed by calling rte_eth_iterator_cleanup().
191  *
192  * @param devargs
193  *   Device description string.
194  *
195  * @return
196  *   0 on successful initialization, negative otherwise.
197  */
198 int rte_eth_iterator_init(struct rte_dev_iterator *iter, const char *devargs);
199 
200 /**
201  * Iterates on devices with devargs filter.
202  * The ownership is not checked.
203  *
204  * The next port ID is returned, and the iterator is updated.
205  *
206  * @param iter
207  *   Device iterator handle initialized by rte_eth_iterator_init().
208  *   Some fields bus_str and cls_str might be freed when no more port is found,
209  *   by calling rte_eth_iterator_cleanup().
210  *
211  * @return
212  *   A port ID if found, RTE_MAX_ETHPORTS otherwise.
213  */
214 uint16_t rte_eth_iterator_next(struct rte_dev_iterator *iter);
215 
216 /**
217  * Free some allocated fields of the iterator.
218  *
219  * This function is automatically called by rte_eth_iterator_next()
220  * on the last iteration (i.e. when no more matching port is found).
221  *
222  * It is safe to call this function twice; it will do nothing more.
223  *
224  * @param iter
225  *   Device iterator handle initialized by rte_eth_iterator_init().
226  *   The fields bus_str and cls_str are freed if needed.
227  */
228 void rte_eth_iterator_cleanup(struct rte_dev_iterator *iter);
229 
230 /**
231  * Macro to iterate over all ethdev ports matching some devargs.
232  *
233  * If a break is done before the end of the loop,
234  * the function rte_eth_iterator_cleanup() must be called.
235  *
236  * @param id
237  *   Iterated port ID of type uint16_t.
238  * @param devargs
239  *   Device parameters input as string of type char*.
240  * @param iter
241  *   Iterator handle of type struct rte_dev_iterator, used internally.
242  */
243 #define RTE_ETH_FOREACH_MATCHING_DEV(id, devargs, iter) \
244 	for (rte_eth_iterator_init(iter, devargs), \
245 	     id = rte_eth_iterator_next(iter); \
246 	     id != RTE_MAX_ETHPORTS; \
247 	     id = rte_eth_iterator_next(iter))
248 
249 /**
250  * A structure used to retrieve statistics for an Ethernet port.
251  * Not all statistics fields in struct rte_eth_stats are supported
252  * by any type of network interface card (NIC). If any statistics
253  * field is not supported, its value is 0.
254  * All byte-related statistics do not include Ethernet FCS regardless
255  * of whether these bytes have been delivered to the application
256  * (see RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_KEEP_CRC).
257  */
258 struct rte_eth_stats {
259 	uint64_t ipackets;  /**< Total number of successfully received packets. */
260 	uint64_t opackets;  /**< Total number of successfully transmitted packets.*/
261 	uint64_t ibytes;    /**< Total number of successfully received bytes. */
262 	uint64_t obytes;    /**< Total number of successfully transmitted bytes. */
263 	/**
264 	 * Total of Rx packets dropped by the HW,
265 	 * because there are no available buffer (i.e. Rx queues are full).
266 	 */
267 	uint64_t imissed;
268 	uint64_t ierrors;   /**< Total number of erroneous received packets. */
269 	uint64_t oerrors;   /**< Total number of failed transmitted packets. */
270 	uint64_t rx_nombuf; /**< Total number of Rx mbuf allocation failures. */
271 	/* Queue stats are limited to max 256 queues */
272 	/** Total number of queue Rx packets. */
273 	uint64_t q_ipackets[RTE_ETHDEV_QUEUE_STAT_CNTRS];
274 	/** Total number of queue Tx packets. */
275 	uint64_t q_opackets[RTE_ETHDEV_QUEUE_STAT_CNTRS];
276 	/** Total number of successfully received queue bytes. */
277 	uint64_t q_ibytes[RTE_ETHDEV_QUEUE_STAT_CNTRS];
278 	/** Total number of successfully transmitted queue bytes. */
279 	uint64_t q_obytes[RTE_ETHDEV_QUEUE_STAT_CNTRS];
280 	/** Total number of queue packets received that are dropped. */
281 	uint64_t q_errors[RTE_ETHDEV_QUEUE_STAT_CNTRS];
282 };
283 
284 /**@{@name Link speed capabilities
285  * Device supported speeds bitmap flags
286  */
287 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_SPEED_AUTONEG 0             /**< Autonegotiate (all speeds) */
288 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_SPEED_FIXED   RTE_BIT32(0)  /**< Disable autoneg (fixed speed) */
289 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_SPEED_10M_HD  RTE_BIT32(1)  /**<  10 Mbps half-duplex */
290 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_SPEED_10M     RTE_BIT32(2)  /**<  10 Mbps full-duplex */
291 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_SPEED_100M_HD RTE_BIT32(3)  /**< 100 Mbps half-duplex */
292 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_SPEED_100M    RTE_BIT32(4)  /**< 100 Mbps full-duplex */
293 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_SPEED_1G      RTE_BIT32(5)  /**<   1 Gbps */
294 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_SPEED_2_5G    RTE_BIT32(6)  /**< 2.5 Gbps */
295 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_SPEED_5G      RTE_BIT32(7)  /**<   5 Gbps */
296 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_SPEED_10G     RTE_BIT32(8)  /**<  10 Gbps */
297 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_SPEED_20G     RTE_BIT32(9)  /**<  20 Gbps */
298 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_SPEED_25G     RTE_BIT32(10) /**<  25 Gbps */
299 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_SPEED_40G     RTE_BIT32(11) /**<  40 Gbps */
300 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_SPEED_50G     RTE_BIT32(12) /**<  50 Gbps */
301 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_SPEED_56G     RTE_BIT32(13) /**<  56 Gbps */
302 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_SPEED_100G    RTE_BIT32(14) /**< 100 Gbps */
303 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_SPEED_200G    RTE_BIT32(15) /**< 200 Gbps */
304 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_SPEED_400G    RTE_BIT32(16) /**< 400 Gbps */
305 /**@}*/
306 
307 /**@{@name Link speed
308  * Ethernet numeric link speeds in Mbps
309  */
310 #define RTE_ETH_SPEED_NUM_NONE         0 /**< Not defined */
311 #define RTE_ETH_SPEED_NUM_10M         10 /**<  10 Mbps */
312 #define RTE_ETH_SPEED_NUM_100M       100 /**< 100 Mbps */
313 #define RTE_ETH_SPEED_NUM_1G        1000 /**<   1 Gbps */
314 #define RTE_ETH_SPEED_NUM_2_5G      2500 /**< 2.5 Gbps */
315 #define RTE_ETH_SPEED_NUM_5G        5000 /**<   5 Gbps */
316 #define RTE_ETH_SPEED_NUM_10G      10000 /**<  10 Gbps */
317 #define RTE_ETH_SPEED_NUM_20G      20000 /**<  20 Gbps */
318 #define RTE_ETH_SPEED_NUM_25G      25000 /**<  25 Gbps */
319 #define RTE_ETH_SPEED_NUM_40G      40000 /**<  40 Gbps */
320 #define RTE_ETH_SPEED_NUM_50G      50000 /**<  50 Gbps */
321 #define RTE_ETH_SPEED_NUM_56G      56000 /**<  56 Gbps */
322 #define RTE_ETH_SPEED_NUM_100G    100000 /**< 100 Gbps */
323 #define RTE_ETH_SPEED_NUM_200G    200000 /**< 200 Gbps */
324 #define RTE_ETH_SPEED_NUM_400G    400000 /**< 400 Gbps */
325 #define RTE_ETH_SPEED_NUM_UNKNOWN UINT32_MAX /**< Unknown */
326 /**@}*/
327 
328 /**
329  * A structure used to retrieve link-level information of an Ethernet port.
330  */
331 struct rte_eth_link {
332 	union {
333 		RTE_ATOMIC(uint64_t) val64; /**< used for atomic64 read/write */
334 		__extension__
335 		struct {
336 			uint32_t link_speed;	    /**< RTE_ETH_SPEED_NUM_ */
337 			uint16_t link_duplex  : 1;  /**< RTE_ETH_LINK_[HALF/FULL]_DUPLEX */
338 			uint16_t link_autoneg : 1;  /**< RTE_ETH_LINK_[AUTONEG/FIXED] */
339 			uint16_t link_status  : 1;  /**< RTE_ETH_LINK_[DOWN/UP] */
340 		};
341 	};
342 };
343 
344 /**@{@name Link negotiation
345  * Constants used in link management.
346  */
347 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_HALF_DUPLEX 0 /**< Half-duplex connection (see link_duplex). */
348 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_FULL_DUPLEX 1 /**< Full-duplex connection (see link_duplex). */
349 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_DOWN        0 /**< Link is down (see link_status). */
350 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_UP          1 /**< Link is up (see link_status). */
351 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_FIXED       0 /**< No autonegotiation (see link_autoneg). */
352 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_AUTONEG     1 /**< Autonegotiated (see link_autoneg). */
353 #define RTE_ETH_LINK_MAX_STR_LEN 40 /**< Max length of default link string. */
354 /**@}*/
355 
356 /** Translate from link speed lanes to speed lanes capabilities. */
357 #define RTE_ETH_SPEED_LANES_TO_CAPA(x) RTE_BIT32(x)
358 
359 /** A structure used to get and set lanes capabilities per link speed. */
360 struct rte_eth_speed_lanes_capa {
361 	uint32_t speed;
362 	uint32_t capa;
363 };
364 
365 /**
366  * A structure used to configure the ring threshold registers of an Rx/Tx
367  * queue for an Ethernet port.
368  */
369 struct rte_eth_thresh {
370 	uint8_t pthresh; /**< Ring prefetch threshold. */
371 	uint8_t hthresh; /**< Ring host threshold. */
372 	uint8_t wthresh; /**< Ring writeback threshold. */
373 };
374 
375 /**@{@name Multi-queue mode
376  * @see rte_eth_conf.rxmode.mq_mode.
377  */
378 #define RTE_ETH_MQ_RX_RSS_FLAG  RTE_BIT32(0) /**< Enable RSS. @see rte_eth_rss_conf */
379 #define RTE_ETH_MQ_RX_DCB_FLAG  RTE_BIT32(1) /**< Enable DCB. */
380 #define RTE_ETH_MQ_RX_VMDQ_FLAG RTE_BIT32(2) /**< Enable VMDq. */
381 /**@}*/
382 
383 /**
384  *  A set of values to identify what method is to be used to route
385  *  packets to multiple queues.
386  */
387 enum rte_eth_rx_mq_mode {
388 	/** None of DCB, RSS or VMDq mode */
389 	RTE_ETH_MQ_RX_NONE = 0,
390 
391 	/** For Rx side, only RSS is on */
392 	RTE_ETH_MQ_RX_RSS = RTE_ETH_MQ_RX_RSS_FLAG,
393 	/** For Rx side,only DCB is on. */
394 	RTE_ETH_MQ_RX_DCB = RTE_ETH_MQ_RX_DCB_FLAG,
395 	/** Both DCB and RSS enable */
396 	RTE_ETH_MQ_RX_DCB_RSS = RTE_ETH_MQ_RX_RSS_FLAG | RTE_ETH_MQ_RX_DCB_FLAG,
397 
398 	/** Only VMDq, no RSS nor DCB */
399 	RTE_ETH_MQ_RX_VMDQ_ONLY = RTE_ETH_MQ_RX_VMDQ_FLAG,
400 	/** RSS mode with VMDq */
401 	RTE_ETH_MQ_RX_VMDQ_RSS = RTE_ETH_MQ_RX_RSS_FLAG | RTE_ETH_MQ_RX_VMDQ_FLAG,
402 	/** Use VMDq+DCB to route traffic to queues */
403 	RTE_ETH_MQ_RX_VMDQ_DCB = RTE_ETH_MQ_RX_VMDQ_FLAG | RTE_ETH_MQ_RX_DCB_FLAG,
404 	/** Enable both VMDq and DCB in VMDq */
405 	RTE_ETH_MQ_RX_VMDQ_DCB_RSS = RTE_ETH_MQ_RX_RSS_FLAG | RTE_ETH_MQ_RX_DCB_FLAG |
406 				 RTE_ETH_MQ_RX_VMDQ_FLAG,
407 };
408 
409 /**
410  * A set of values to identify what method is to be used to transmit
411  * packets using multi-TCs.
412  */
413 enum rte_eth_tx_mq_mode {
414 	RTE_ETH_MQ_TX_NONE    = 0,  /**< It is in neither DCB nor VT mode. */
415 	RTE_ETH_MQ_TX_DCB,          /**< For Tx side,only DCB is on. */
416 	RTE_ETH_MQ_TX_VMDQ_DCB,     /**< For Tx side,both DCB and VT is on. */
417 	RTE_ETH_MQ_TX_VMDQ_ONLY,    /**< Only VT on, no DCB */
418 };
419 
420 /**
421  * A structure used to configure the Rx features of an Ethernet port.
422  */
423 struct rte_eth_rxmode {
424 	/** The multi-queue packet distribution mode to be used, e.g. RSS. */
425 	enum rte_eth_rx_mq_mode mq_mode;
426 	uint32_t mtu;  /**< Requested MTU. */
427 	/** Maximum allowed size of LRO aggregated packet. */
428 	uint32_t max_lro_pkt_size;
429 	/**
430 	 * Per-port Rx offloads to be set using RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_* flags.
431 	 * Only offloads set on rx_offload_capa field on rte_eth_dev_info
432 	 * structure are allowed to be set.
433 	 */
434 	uint64_t offloads;
435 
436 	uint64_t reserved_64s[2]; /**< Reserved for future fields */
437 	void *reserved_ptrs[2];   /**< Reserved for future fields */
438 };
439 
440 /**
441  * VLAN types to indicate if it is for single VLAN, inner VLAN or outer VLAN.
442  * Note that single VLAN is treated the same as inner VLAN.
443  */
444 enum rte_vlan_type {
445 	RTE_ETH_VLAN_TYPE_UNKNOWN = 0,
446 	RTE_ETH_VLAN_TYPE_INNER, /**< Inner VLAN. */
447 	RTE_ETH_VLAN_TYPE_OUTER, /**< Single VLAN, or outer VLAN. */
448 	RTE_ETH_VLAN_TYPE_MAX,
449 };
450 
451 /**
452  * A structure used to describe a VLAN filter.
453  * If the bit corresponding to a VID is set, such VID is on.
454  */
455 struct rte_vlan_filter_conf {
456 	uint64_t ids[64];
457 };
458 
459 /**
460  * Hash function types.
461  */
462 enum rte_eth_hash_function {
463 	/** DEFAULT means driver decides which hash algorithm to pick. */
464 	RTE_ETH_HASH_FUNCTION_DEFAULT = 0,
465 	RTE_ETH_HASH_FUNCTION_TOEPLITZ, /**< Toeplitz */
466 	RTE_ETH_HASH_FUNCTION_SIMPLE_XOR, /**< Simple XOR */
467 	/**
468 	 * Symmetric Toeplitz: src, dst will be replaced by
469 	 * xor(src, dst). For the case with src/dst only,
470 	 * src or dst address will xor with zero pair.
471 	 */
472 	RTE_ETH_HASH_FUNCTION_SYMMETRIC_TOEPLITZ,
473 	/**
474 	 * Symmetric Toeplitz: L3 and L4 fields are sorted prior to
475 	 * the hash function.
476 	 *  If src_ip > dst_ip, swap src_ip and dst_ip.
477 	 *  If src_port > dst_port, swap src_port and dst_port.
478 	 */
479 	RTE_ETH_HASH_FUNCTION_SYMMETRIC_TOEPLITZ_SORT,
480 	RTE_ETH_HASH_FUNCTION_MAX,
481 };
482 
483 #define RTE_ETH_HASH_ALGO_TO_CAPA(x) RTE_BIT32(x)
484 #define RTE_ETH_HASH_ALGO_CAPA_MASK(x) RTE_BIT32(RTE_ETH_HASH_FUNCTION_ ## x)
485 
486 /**
487  * A structure used to configure the Receive Side Scaling (RSS) feature
488  * of an Ethernet port.
489  */
490 struct rte_eth_rss_conf {
491 	/**
492 	 * In rte_eth_dev_rss_hash_conf_get(), the *rss_key_len* should be
493 	 * greater than or equal to the *hash_key_size* which get from
494 	 * rte_eth_dev_info_get() API. And the *rss_key* should contain at least
495 	 * *hash_key_size* bytes. If not meet these requirements, the query
496 	 * result is unreliable even if the operation returns success.
497 	 *
498 	 * In rte_eth_dev_rss_hash_update() or rte_eth_dev_configure(), if
499 	 * *rss_key* is not NULL, the *rss_key_len* indicates the length of the
500 	 * *rss_key* in bytes and it should be equal to *hash_key_size*.
501 	 * If *rss_key* is NULL, drivers are free to use a random or a default key.
502 	 */
503 	uint8_t *rss_key;
504 	uint8_t rss_key_len; /**< hash key length in bytes. */
505 	/**
506 	 * Indicates the type of packets or the specific part of packets to
507 	 * which RSS hashing is to be applied.
508 	 */
509 	uint64_t rss_hf;
510 	enum rte_eth_hash_function algorithm;	/**< Hash algorithm. */
511 };
512 
513 /*
514  * A packet can be identified by hardware as different flow types. Different
515  * NIC hardware may support different flow types.
516  * Basically, the NIC hardware identifies the flow type as deep protocol as
517  * possible, and exclusively. For example, if a packet is identified as
518  * 'RTE_ETH_FLOW_NONFRAG_IPV4_TCP', it will not be any of other flow types,
519  * though it is an actual IPV4 packet.
520  */
521 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_UNKNOWN             0
522 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_RAW                 1
523 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_IPV4                2
524 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_FRAG_IPV4           3
525 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_NONFRAG_IPV4_TCP    4
526 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_NONFRAG_IPV4_UDP    5
527 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_NONFRAG_IPV4_SCTP   6
528 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_NONFRAG_IPV4_OTHER  7
529 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_IPV6                8
530 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_FRAG_IPV6           9
531 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_NONFRAG_IPV6_TCP   10
532 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_NONFRAG_IPV6_UDP   11
533 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_NONFRAG_IPV6_SCTP  12
534 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_NONFRAG_IPV6_OTHER 13
535 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_L2_PAYLOAD         14
536 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_IPV6_EX            15
537 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_IPV6_TCP_EX        16
538 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_IPV6_UDP_EX        17
539 /** Consider device port number as a flow differentiator */
540 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_PORT               18
541 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_VXLAN              19 /**< VXLAN protocol based flow */
542 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_GENEVE             20 /**< GENEVE protocol based flow */
543 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_NVGRE              21 /**< NVGRE protocol based flow */
544 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_VXLAN_GPE          22 /**< VXLAN-GPE protocol based flow */
545 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_GTPU               23 /**< GTPU protocol based flow */
546 #define RTE_ETH_FLOW_MAX                24
547 
548 /*
549  * Below macros are defined for RSS offload types, they can be used to
550  * fill rte_eth_rss_conf.rss_hf or rte_flow_action_rss.types.
551  */
552 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV4               RTE_BIT64(2)
553 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_FRAG_IPV4          RTE_BIT64(3)
554 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV4_TCP   RTE_BIT64(4)
555 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV4_UDP   RTE_BIT64(5)
556 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV4_SCTP  RTE_BIT64(6)
557 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV4_OTHER RTE_BIT64(7)
558 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6               RTE_BIT64(8)
559 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_FRAG_IPV6          RTE_BIT64(9)
560 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_TCP   RTE_BIT64(10)
561 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_UDP   RTE_BIT64(11)
562 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_SCTP  RTE_BIT64(12)
563 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_OTHER RTE_BIT64(13)
564 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_L2_PAYLOAD         RTE_BIT64(14)
565 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_EX            RTE_BIT64(15)
566 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_TCP_EX        RTE_BIT64(16)
567 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_UDP_EX        RTE_BIT64(17)
568 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_PORT               RTE_BIT64(18)
569 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_VXLAN              RTE_BIT64(19)
570 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_GENEVE             RTE_BIT64(20)
571 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_NVGRE              RTE_BIT64(21)
572 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_GTPU               RTE_BIT64(23)
573 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_ETH                RTE_BIT64(24)
574 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_S_VLAN             RTE_BIT64(25)
575 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_C_VLAN             RTE_BIT64(26)
576 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_ESP                RTE_BIT64(27)
577 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_AH                 RTE_BIT64(28)
578 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_L2TPV3             RTE_BIT64(29)
579 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_PFCP               RTE_BIT64(30)
580 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_PPPOE              RTE_BIT64(31)
581 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_ECPRI              RTE_BIT64(32)
582 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_MPLS               RTE_BIT64(33)
583 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV4_CHKSUM        RTE_BIT64(34)
584 
585 /**
586  * The RTE_ETH_RSS_L4_CHKSUM works on checksum field of any L4 header.
587  * It is similar to RTE_ETH_RSS_PORT that they don't specify the specific type of
588  * L4 header. This macro is defined to replace some specific L4 (TCP/UDP/SCTP)
589  * checksum type for constructing the use of RSS offload bits.
590  *
591  * Due to above reason, some old APIs (and configuration) don't support
592  * RTE_ETH_RSS_L4_CHKSUM. The rte_flow RSS API supports it.
593  *
594  * For the case that checksum is not used in an UDP header,
595  * it takes the reserved value 0 as input for the hash function.
596  */
597 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_L4_CHKSUM          RTE_BIT64(35)
598 
599 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_L2TPV2             RTE_BIT64(36)
600 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_FLOW_LABEL    RTE_BIT64(37)
601 
602 /*
603  * We use the following macros to combine with above RTE_ETH_RSS_* for
604  * more specific input set selection. These bits are defined starting
605  * from the high end of the 64 bits.
606  * Note: If we use above RTE_ETH_RSS_* without SRC/DST_ONLY, it represents
607  * both SRC and DST are taken into account. If SRC_ONLY and DST_ONLY of
608  * the same level are used simultaneously, it is the same case as none of
609  * them are added.
610  */
611 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_SRC_ONLY        RTE_BIT64(63)
612 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_DST_ONLY        RTE_BIT64(62)
613 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_L4_SRC_ONLY        RTE_BIT64(61)
614 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_L4_DST_ONLY        RTE_BIT64(60)
615 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_L2_SRC_ONLY        RTE_BIT64(59)
616 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_L2_DST_ONLY        RTE_BIT64(58)
617 
618 /*
619  * Only select IPV6 address prefix as RSS input set according to
620  * https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc6052
621  * Must be combined with RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6, RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_UDP,
622  * RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_TCP, RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_SCTP.
623  */
624 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE32           RTE_BIT64(57)
625 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE40           RTE_BIT64(56)
626 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE48           RTE_BIT64(55)
627 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE56           RTE_BIT64(54)
628 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE64           RTE_BIT64(53)
629 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE96           RTE_BIT64(52)
630 
631 /*
632  * Use the following macros to combine with the above layers
633  * to choose inner and outer layers or both for RSS computation.
634  * Bits 50 and 51 are reserved for this.
635  */
636 
637 /**
638  * level 0, requests the default behavior.
639  * Depending on the packet type, it can mean outermost, innermost,
640  * anything in between or even no RSS.
641  * It basically stands for the innermost encapsulation level RSS
642  * can be performed on according to PMD and device capabilities.
643  */
644 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_LEVEL_PMD_DEFAULT  (UINT64_C(0) << 50)
645 
646 /**
647  * level 1, requests RSS to be performed on the outermost packet
648  * encapsulation level.
649  */
650 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_LEVEL_OUTERMOST    (UINT64_C(1) << 50)
651 
652 /**
653  * level 2, requests RSS to be performed on the specified inner packet
654  * encapsulation level, from outermost to innermost (lower to higher values).
655  */
656 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_LEVEL_INNERMOST    (UINT64_C(2) << 50)
657 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_LEVEL_MASK         (UINT64_C(3) << 50)
658 
659 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_LEVEL(rss_hf) ((rss_hf & RTE_ETH_RSS_LEVEL_MASK) >> 50)
660 
661 /**
662  * For input set change of hash filter, if SRC_ONLY and DST_ONLY of
663  * the same level are used simultaneously, it is the same case as
664  * none of them are added.
665  *
666  * @param rss_hf
667  *   RSS types with SRC/DST_ONLY.
668  * @return
669  *   RSS types.
670  */
671 static inline uint64_t
672 rte_eth_rss_hf_refine(uint64_t rss_hf)
673 {
674 	if ((rss_hf & RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_SRC_ONLY) && (rss_hf & RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_DST_ONLY))
675 		rss_hf &= ~(RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_SRC_ONLY | RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_DST_ONLY);
676 
677 	if ((rss_hf & RTE_ETH_RSS_L4_SRC_ONLY) && (rss_hf & RTE_ETH_RSS_L4_DST_ONLY))
678 		rss_hf &= ~(RTE_ETH_RSS_L4_SRC_ONLY | RTE_ETH_RSS_L4_DST_ONLY);
679 
680 	return rss_hf;
681 }
682 
683 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_PRE32 ( \
684 		RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6 | \
685 		RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE32)
686 
687 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_PRE40 ( \
688 		RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6 | \
689 		RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE40)
690 
691 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_PRE48 ( \
692 		RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6 | \
693 		RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE48)
694 
695 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_PRE56 ( \
696 		RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6 | \
697 		RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE56)
698 
699 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_PRE64 ( \
700 		RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6 | \
701 		RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE64)
702 
703 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_PRE96 ( \
704 		RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6 | \
705 		RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE96)
706 
707 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_PRE32_UDP ( \
708 		RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_UDP | \
709 		RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE32)
710 
711 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_PRE40_UDP ( \
712 		RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_UDP | \
713 		RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE40)
714 
715 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_PRE48_UDP ( \
716 		RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_UDP | \
717 		RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE48)
718 
719 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_PRE56_UDP ( \
720 		RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_UDP | \
721 		RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE56)
722 
723 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_PRE64_UDP ( \
724 		RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_UDP | \
725 		RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE64)
726 
727 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_PRE96_UDP ( \
728 		RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_UDP | \
729 		RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE96)
730 
731 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_PRE32_TCP ( \
732 		RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_TCP | \
733 		RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE32)
734 
735 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_PRE40_TCP ( \
736 		RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_TCP | \
737 		RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE40)
738 
739 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_PRE48_TCP ( \
740 		RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_TCP | \
741 		RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE48)
742 
743 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_PRE56_TCP ( \
744 		RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_TCP | \
745 		RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE56)
746 
747 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_PRE64_TCP ( \
748 		RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_TCP | \
749 		RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE64)
750 
751 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_PRE96_TCP ( \
752 		RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_TCP | \
753 		RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE96)
754 
755 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_PRE32_SCTP ( \
756 		RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_SCTP | \
757 		RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE32)
758 
759 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_PRE40_SCTP ( \
760 		RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_SCTP | \
761 		RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE40)
762 
763 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_PRE48_SCTP ( \
764 		RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_SCTP | \
765 		RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE48)
766 
767 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_PRE56_SCTP ( \
768 		RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_SCTP | \
769 		RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE56)
770 
771 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_PRE64_SCTP ( \
772 		RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_SCTP | \
773 		RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE64)
774 
775 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_PRE96_SCTP ( \
776 		RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_SCTP | \
777 		RTE_ETH_RSS_L3_PRE96)
778 
779 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_IP ( \
780 	RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV4 | \
781 	RTE_ETH_RSS_FRAG_IPV4 | \
782 	RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV4_OTHER | \
783 	RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6 | \
784 	RTE_ETH_RSS_FRAG_IPV6 | \
785 	RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_OTHER | \
786 	RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_EX)
787 
788 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_UDP ( \
789 	RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV4_UDP | \
790 	RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_UDP | \
791 	RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_UDP_EX)
792 
793 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_TCP ( \
794 	RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV4_TCP | \
795 	RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_TCP | \
796 	RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_TCP_EX)
797 
798 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_SCTP ( \
799 	RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV4_SCTP | \
800 	RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_SCTP)
801 
802 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_TUNNEL ( \
803 	RTE_ETH_RSS_VXLAN  | \
804 	RTE_ETH_RSS_GENEVE | \
805 	RTE_ETH_RSS_NVGRE)
806 
807 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_VLAN ( \
808 	RTE_ETH_RSS_S_VLAN  | \
809 	RTE_ETH_RSS_C_VLAN)
810 
811 /** Mask of valid RSS hash protocols */
812 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_PROTO_MASK ( \
813 	RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV4 | \
814 	RTE_ETH_RSS_FRAG_IPV4 | \
815 	RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV4_TCP | \
816 	RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV4_UDP | \
817 	RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV4_SCTP | \
818 	RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV4_OTHER | \
819 	RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6 | \
820 	RTE_ETH_RSS_FRAG_IPV6 | \
821 	RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_TCP | \
822 	RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_UDP | \
823 	RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_SCTP | \
824 	RTE_ETH_RSS_NONFRAG_IPV6_OTHER | \
825 	RTE_ETH_RSS_L2_PAYLOAD | \
826 	RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_EX | \
827 	RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_TCP_EX | \
828 	RTE_ETH_RSS_IPV6_UDP_EX | \
829 	RTE_ETH_RSS_PORT  | \
830 	RTE_ETH_RSS_VXLAN | \
831 	RTE_ETH_RSS_GENEVE | \
832 	RTE_ETH_RSS_NVGRE | \
833 	RTE_ETH_RSS_MPLS)
834 
835 /*
836  * Definitions used for redirection table entry size.
837  * Some RSS RETA sizes may not be supported by some drivers, check the
838  * documentation or the description of relevant functions for more details.
839  */
840 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_RETA_SIZE_64  64
841 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_RETA_SIZE_128 128
842 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_RETA_SIZE_256 256
843 #define RTE_ETH_RSS_RETA_SIZE_512 512
844 #define RTE_ETH_RETA_GROUP_SIZE   64
845 
846 /**@{@name VMDq and DCB maximums */
847 #define RTE_ETH_VMDQ_MAX_VLAN_FILTERS   64 /**< Maximum nb. of VMDq VLAN filters. */
848 #define RTE_ETH_DCB_NUM_USER_PRIORITIES 8  /**< Maximum nb. of DCB priorities. */
849 #define RTE_ETH_VMDQ_DCB_NUM_QUEUES     128 /**< Maximum nb. of VMDq DCB queues. */
850 #define RTE_ETH_DCB_NUM_QUEUES          128 /**< Maximum nb. of DCB queues. */
851 /**@}*/
852 
853 /**@{@name DCB capabilities */
854 #define RTE_ETH_DCB_PG_SUPPORT      RTE_BIT32(0) /**< Priority Group(ETS) support. */
855 #define RTE_ETH_DCB_PFC_SUPPORT     RTE_BIT32(1) /**< Priority Flow Control support. */
856 /**@}*/
857 
858 /**@{@name VLAN offload bits */
859 #define RTE_ETH_VLAN_STRIP_OFFLOAD   0x0001 /**< VLAN Strip  On/Off */
860 #define RTE_ETH_VLAN_FILTER_OFFLOAD  0x0002 /**< VLAN Filter On/Off */
861 #define RTE_ETH_VLAN_EXTEND_OFFLOAD  0x0004 /**< VLAN Extend On/Off */
862 #define RTE_ETH_QINQ_STRIP_OFFLOAD   0x0008 /**< QINQ Strip On/Off */
863 
864 #define RTE_ETH_VLAN_STRIP_MASK      0x0001 /**< VLAN Strip  setting mask */
865 #define RTE_ETH_VLAN_FILTER_MASK     0x0002 /**< VLAN Filter  setting mask*/
866 #define RTE_ETH_VLAN_EXTEND_MASK     0x0004 /**< VLAN Extend  setting mask*/
867 #define RTE_ETH_QINQ_STRIP_MASK      0x0008 /**< QINQ Strip  setting mask */
868 #define RTE_ETH_VLAN_ID_MAX          0x0FFF /**< VLAN ID is in lower 12 bits*/
869 /**@}*/
870 
871 /* Definitions used for receive MAC address */
872 #define RTE_ETH_NUM_RECEIVE_MAC_ADDR   128 /**< Maximum nb. of receive mac addr. */
873 
874 /* Definitions used for unicast hash */
875 #define RTE_ETH_VMDQ_NUM_UC_HASH_ARRAY 128 /**< Maximum nb. of UC hash array. */
876 
877 /**@{@name VMDq Rx mode
878  * @see rte_eth_vmdq_rx_conf.rx_mode
879  */
880 /** Accept untagged packets. */
881 #define RTE_ETH_VMDQ_ACCEPT_UNTAG      RTE_BIT32(0)
882 /** Accept packets in multicast table. */
883 #define RTE_ETH_VMDQ_ACCEPT_HASH_MC    RTE_BIT32(1)
884 /** Accept packets in unicast table. */
885 #define RTE_ETH_VMDQ_ACCEPT_HASH_UC    RTE_BIT32(2)
886 /** Accept broadcast packets. */
887 #define RTE_ETH_VMDQ_ACCEPT_BROADCAST  RTE_BIT32(3)
888 /** Multicast promiscuous. */
889 #define RTE_ETH_VMDQ_ACCEPT_MULTICAST  RTE_BIT32(4)
890 /**@}*/
891 
892 /**
893  * A structure used to configure 64 entries of Redirection Table of the
894  * Receive Side Scaling (RSS) feature of an Ethernet port. To configure
895  * more than 64 entries supported by hardware, an array of this structure
896  * is needed.
897  */
898 struct rte_eth_rss_reta_entry64 {
899 	/** Mask bits indicate which entries need to be updated/queried. */
900 	uint64_t mask;
901 	/** Group of 64 redirection table entries. */
902 	uint16_t reta[RTE_ETH_RETA_GROUP_SIZE];
903 };
904 
905 /**
906  * This enum indicates the possible number of traffic classes
907  * in DCB configurations
908  */
909 enum rte_eth_nb_tcs {
910 	RTE_ETH_4_TCS = 4, /**< 4 TCs with DCB. */
911 	RTE_ETH_8_TCS = 8  /**< 8 TCs with DCB. */
912 };
913 
914 /**
915  * This enum indicates the possible number of queue pools
916  * in VMDq configurations.
917  */
918 enum rte_eth_nb_pools {
919 	RTE_ETH_8_POOLS = 8,    /**< 8 VMDq pools. */
920 	RTE_ETH_16_POOLS = 16,  /**< 16 VMDq pools. */
921 	RTE_ETH_32_POOLS = 32,  /**< 32 VMDq pools. */
922 	RTE_ETH_64_POOLS = 64   /**< 64 VMDq pools. */
923 };
924 
925 /* This structure may be extended in future. */
926 struct rte_eth_dcb_rx_conf {
927 	enum rte_eth_nb_tcs nb_tcs; /**< Possible DCB TCs, 4 or 8 TCs */
928 	/** Traffic class each UP mapped to. */
929 	uint8_t dcb_tc[RTE_ETH_DCB_NUM_USER_PRIORITIES];
930 };
931 
932 struct rte_eth_vmdq_dcb_tx_conf {
933 	enum rte_eth_nb_pools nb_queue_pools; /**< With DCB, 16 or 32 pools. */
934 	/** Traffic class each UP mapped to. */
935 	uint8_t dcb_tc[RTE_ETH_DCB_NUM_USER_PRIORITIES];
936 };
937 
938 struct rte_eth_dcb_tx_conf {
939 	enum rte_eth_nb_tcs nb_tcs; /**< Possible DCB TCs, 4 or 8 TCs. */
940 	/** Traffic class each UP mapped to. */
941 	uint8_t dcb_tc[RTE_ETH_DCB_NUM_USER_PRIORITIES];
942 };
943 
944 struct rte_eth_vmdq_tx_conf {
945 	enum rte_eth_nb_pools nb_queue_pools; /**< VMDq mode, 64 pools. */
946 };
947 
948 /**
949  * A structure used to configure the VMDq+DCB feature
950  * of an Ethernet port.
951  *
952  * Using this feature, packets are routed to a pool of queues, based
953  * on the VLAN ID in the VLAN tag, and then to a specific queue within
954  * that pool, using the user priority VLAN tag field.
955  *
956  * A default pool may be used, if desired, to route all traffic which
957  * does not match the VLAN filter rules.
958  */
959 struct rte_eth_vmdq_dcb_conf {
960 	enum rte_eth_nb_pools nb_queue_pools; /**< With DCB, 16 or 32 pools */
961 	uint8_t enable_default_pool; /**< If non-zero, use a default pool */
962 	uint8_t default_pool; /**< The default pool, if applicable */
963 	uint8_t nb_pool_maps; /**< We can have up to 64 filters/mappings */
964 	struct {
965 		uint16_t vlan_id; /**< The VLAN ID of the received frame */
966 		uint64_t pools;   /**< Bitmask of pools for packet Rx */
967 	} pool_map[RTE_ETH_VMDQ_MAX_VLAN_FILTERS]; /**< VMDq VLAN pool maps. */
968 	/** Selects a queue in a pool */
969 	uint8_t dcb_tc[RTE_ETH_DCB_NUM_USER_PRIORITIES];
970 };
971 
972 /**
973  * A structure used to configure the VMDq feature of an Ethernet port when
974  * not combined with the DCB feature.
975  *
976  * Using this feature, packets are routed to a pool of queues. By default,
977  * the pool selection is based on the MAC address, the VLAN ID in the
978  * VLAN tag as specified in the pool_map array.
979  * Passing the RTE_ETH_VMDQ_ACCEPT_UNTAG in the rx_mode field allows pool
980  * selection using only the MAC address. MAC address to pool mapping is done
981  * using the rte_eth_dev_mac_addr_add function, with the pool parameter
982  * corresponding to the pool ID.
983  *
984  * Queue selection within the selected pool will be done using RSS when
985  * it is enabled or revert to the first queue of the pool if not.
986  *
987  * A default pool may be used, if desired, to route all traffic which
988  * does not match the VLAN filter rules or any pool MAC address.
989  */
990 struct rte_eth_vmdq_rx_conf {
991 	enum rte_eth_nb_pools nb_queue_pools; /**< VMDq only mode, 8 or 64 pools */
992 	uint8_t enable_default_pool; /**< If non-zero, use a default pool */
993 	uint8_t default_pool; /**< The default pool, if applicable */
994 	uint8_t enable_loop_back; /**< Enable VT loop back */
995 	uint8_t nb_pool_maps; /**< We can have up to 64 filters/mappings */
996 	uint32_t rx_mode; /**< Flags from RTE_ETH_VMDQ_ACCEPT_* */
997 	struct {
998 		uint16_t vlan_id; /**< The VLAN ID of the received frame */
999 		uint64_t pools;   /**< Bitmask of pools for packet Rx */
1000 	} pool_map[RTE_ETH_VMDQ_MAX_VLAN_FILTERS]; /**< VMDq VLAN pool maps. */
1001 };
1002 
1003 /**
1004  * A structure used to configure the Tx features of an Ethernet port.
1005  */
1006 struct rte_eth_txmode {
1007 	enum rte_eth_tx_mq_mode mq_mode; /**< Tx multi-queues mode. */
1008 	/**
1009 	 * Per-port Tx offloads to be set using RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_* flags.
1010 	 * Only offloads set on tx_offload_capa field on rte_eth_dev_info
1011 	 * structure are allowed to be set.
1012 	 */
1013 	uint64_t offloads;
1014 
1015 	uint16_t pvid;
1016 	__extension__
1017 	uint8_t /** If set, reject sending out tagged pkts */
1018 		hw_vlan_reject_tagged : 1,
1019 		/** If set, reject sending out untagged pkts */
1020 		hw_vlan_reject_untagged : 1,
1021 		/** If set, enable port based VLAN insertion */
1022 		hw_vlan_insert_pvid : 1;
1023 
1024 	uint64_t reserved_64s[2]; /**< Reserved for future fields */
1025 	void *reserved_ptrs[2];   /**< Reserved for future fields */
1026 };
1027 
1028 /**
1029  * @warning
1030  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this structure may change without prior notice.
1031  *
1032  * A structure used to configure an Rx packet segment to split.
1033  *
1034  * If RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_BUFFER_SPLIT flag is set in offloads field,
1035  * the PMD will split the received packets into multiple segments
1036  * according to the specification in the description array:
1037  *
1038  * - The first network buffer will be allocated from the memory pool,
1039  *   specified in the first array element, the second buffer, from the
1040  *   pool in the second element, and so on.
1041  *
1042  * - The proto_hdrs in the elements define the split position of
1043  *   received packets.
1044  *
1045  * - The offsets from the segment description elements specify
1046  *   the data offset from the buffer beginning except the first mbuf.
1047  *   The first segment offset is added with RTE_PKTMBUF_HEADROOM.
1048  *
1049  * - The lengths in the elements define the maximal data amount
1050  *   being received to each segment. The receiving starts with filling
1051  *   up the first mbuf data buffer up to specified length. If the
1052  *   there are data remaining (packet is longer than buffer in the first
1053  *   mbuf) the following data will be pushed to the next segment
1054  *   up to its own length, and so on.
1055  *
1056  * - If the length in the segment description element is zero
1057  *   the actual buffer size will be deduced from the appropriate
1058  *   memory pool properties.
1059  *
1060  * - If there is not enough elements to describe the buffer for entire
1061  *   packet of maximal length the following parameters will be used
1062  *   for the all remaining segments:
1063  *     - pool from the last valid element
1064  *     - the buffer size from this pool
1065  *     - zero offset
1066  *
1067  * - Length based buffer split:
1068  *     - mp, length, offset should be configured.
1069  *     - The proto_hdr field must be 0.
1070  *
1071  * - Protocol header based buffer split:
1072  *     - mp, offset, proto_hdr should be configured.
1073  *     - The length field must be 0.
1074  *     - The proto_hdr field in the last segment should be 0.
1075  *
1076  * - When protocol header split is enabled, NIC may receive packets
1077  *   which do not match all the protocol headers within the Rx segments.
1078  *   At this point, NIC will have two possible split behaviors according to
1079  *   matching results, one is exact match, another is longest match.
1080  *   The split result of NIC must belong to one of them.
1081  *   The exact match means NIC only do split when the packets exactly match all
1082  *   the protocol headers in the segments.
1083  *   Otherwise, the whole packet will be put into the last valid mempool.
1084  *   The longest match means NIC will do split until packets mismatch
1085  *   the protocol header in the segments.
1086  *   The rest will be put into the last valid pool.
1087  */
1088 struct rte_eth_rxseg_split {
1089 	struct rte_mempool *mp; /**< Memory pool to allocate segment from. */
1090 	uint16_t length; /**< Segment data length, configures split point. */
1091 	uint16_t offset; /**< Data offset from beginning of mbuf data buffer. */
1092 	/**
1093 	 * proto_hdr defines a bit mask of the protocol sequence as RTE_PTYPE_*.
1094 	 * The last RTE_PTYPE* in the mask indicates the split position.
1095 	 *
1096 	 * If one protocol header is defined to split packets into two segments,
1097 	 * for non-tunneling packets, the complete protocol sequence should be defined.
1098 	 * For tunneling packets, for simplicity, only the tunnel and inner part of
1099 	 * complete protocol sequence is required.
1100 	 * If several protocol headers are defined to split packets into multi-segments,
1101 	 * the repeated parts of adjacent segments should be omitted.
1102 	 */
1103 	uint32_t proto_hdr;
1104 };
1105 
1106 /**
1107  * @warning
1108  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this structure may change without prior notice.
1109  *
1110  * A common structure used to describe Rx packet segment properties.
1111  */
1112 union rte_eth_rxseg {
1113 	/* The settings for buffer split offload. */
1114 	struct rte_eth_rxseg_split split;
1115 	/* The other features settings should be added here. */
1116 };
1117 
1118 /**
1119  * A structure used to configure an Rx ring of an Ethernet port.
1120  */
1121 struct rte_eth_rxconf {
1122 	struct rte_eth_thresh rx_thresh; /**< Rx ring threshold registers. */
1123 	uint16_t rx_free_thresh; /**< Drives the freeing of Rx descriptors. */
1124 	uint8_t rx_drop_en; /**< Drop packets if no descriptors are available. */
1125 	uint8_t rx_deferred_start; /**< Do not start queue with rte_eth_dev_start(). */
1126 	uint16_t rx_nseg; /**< Number of descriptions in rx_seg array. */
1127 	/**
1128 	 * Share group index in Rx domain and switch domain.
1129 	 * Non-zero value to enable Rx queue share, zero value disable share.
1130 	 * PMD is responsible for Rx queue consistency checks to avoid member
1131 	 * port's configuration contradict to each other.
1132 	 */
1133 	uint16_t share_group;
1134 	uint16_t share_qid; /**< Shared Rx queue ID in group */
1135 	/**
1136 	 * Per-queue Rx offloads to be set using RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_* flags.
1137 	 * Only offloads set on rx_queue_offload_capa or rx_offload_capa
1138 	 * fields on rte_eth_dev_info structure are allowed to be set.
1139 	 */
1140 	uint64_t offloads;
1141 	/**
1142 	 * Points to the array of segment descriptions for an entire packet.
1143 	 * Array elements are properties for consecutive Rx segments.
1144 	 *
1145 	 * The supported capabilities of receiving segmentation is reported
1146 	 * in rte_eth_dev_info.rx_seg_capa field.
1147 	 */
1148 	union rte_eth_rxseg *rx_seg;
1149 
1150 	/**
1151 	 * Array of mempools to allocate Rx buffers from.
1152 	 *
1153 	 * This provides support for multiple mbuf pools per Rx queue.
1154 	 * The capability is reported in device info via positive
1155 	 * max_rx_mempools.
1156 	 *
1157 	 * It could be useful for more efficient usage of memory when an
1158 	 * application creates different mempools to steer the specific
1159 	 * size of the packet.
1160 	 *
1161 	 * If many mempools are specified, packets received using Rx
1162 	 * burst may belong to any provided mempool. From ethdev user point
1163 	 * of view it is undefined how PMD/NIC chooses mempool for a packet.
1164 	 *
1165 	 * If Rx scatter is enabled, a packet may be delivered using a chain
1166 	 * of mbufs obtained from single mempool or multiple mempools based
1167 	 * on the NIC implementation.
1168 	 */
1169 	struct rte_mempool **rx_mempools;
1170 	uint16_t rx_nmempool; /** < Number of Rx mempools */
1171 
1172 	uint64_t reserved_64s[2]; /**< Reserved for future fields */
1173 	void *reserved_ptrs[2];   /**< Reserved for future fields */
1174 };
1175 
1176 /**
1177  * A structure used to configure a Tx ring of an Ethernet port.
1178  */
1179 struct rte_eth_txconf {
1180 	struct rte_eth_thresh tx_thresh; /**< Tx ring threshold registers. */
1181 	uint16_t tx_rs_thresh; /**< Drives the setting of RS bit on TXDs. */
1182 	uint16_t tx_free_thresh; /**< Start freeing Tx buffers if there are
1183 				      less free descriptors than this value. */
1184 
1185 	uint8_t tx_deferred_start; /**< Do not start queue with rte_eth_dev_start(). */
1186 	/**
1187 	 * Per-queue Tx offloads to be set  using RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_* flags.
1188 	 * Only offloads set on tx_queue_offload_capa or tx_offload_capa
1189 	 * fields on rte_eth_dev_info structure are allowed to be set.
1190 	 */
1191 	uint64_t offloads;
1192 
1193 	uint64_t reserved_64s[2]; /**< Reserved for future fields */
1194 	void *reserved_ptrs[2];   /**< Reserved for future fields */
1195 };
1196 
1197 /**
1198  * @warning
1199  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
1200  *
1201  * A structure used to return the Tx or Rx hairpin queue capabilities.
1202  */
1203 struct rte_eth_hairpin_queue_cap {
1204 	/**
1205 	 * When set, PMD supports placing descriptors and/or data buffers
1206 	 * in dedicated device memory.
1207 	 */
1208 	uint32_t locked_device_memory:1;
1209 
1210 	/**
1211 	 * When set, PMD supports placing descriptors and/or data buffers
1212 	 * in host memory managed by DPDK.
1213 	 */
1214 	uint32_t rte_memory:1;
1215 
1216 	uint32_t reserved:30; /**< Reserved for future fields */
1217 };
1218 
1219 /**
1220  * @warning
1221  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
1222  *
1223  * A structure used to return the hairpin capabilities that are supported.
1224  */
1225 struct rte_eth_hairpin_cap {
1226 	/** The max number of hairpin queues (different bindings). */
1227 	uint16_t max_nb_queues;
1228 	/** Max number of Rx queues to be connected to one Tx queue. */
1229 	uint16_t max_rx_2_tx;
1230 	/** Max number of Tx queues to be connected to one Rx queue. */
1231 	uint16_t max_tx_2_rx;
1232 	uint16_t max_nb_desc; /**< The max num of descriptors. */
1233 	struct rte_eth_hairpin_queue_cap rx_cap; /**< Rx hairpin queue capabilities. */
1234 	struct rte_eth_hairpin_queue_cap tx_cap; /**< Tx hairpin queue capabilities. */
1235 };
1236 
1237 #define RTE_ETH_MAX_HAIRPIN_PEERS 32
1238 
1239 /**
1240  * @warning
1241  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
1242  *
1243  * A structure used to hold hairpin peer data.
1244  */
1245 struct rte_eth_hairpin_peer {
1246 	uint16_t port; /**< Peer port. */
1247 	uint16_t queue; /**< Peer queue. */
1248 };
1249 
1250 /**
1251  * @warning
1252  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
1253  *
1254  * A structure used to configure hairpin binding.
1255  */
1256 struct rte_eth_hairpin_conf {
1257 	uint32_t peer_count:16; /**< The number of peers. */
1258 
1259 	/**
1260 	 * Explicit Tx flow rule mode.
1261 	 * One hairpin pair of queues should have the same attribute.
1262 	 *
1263 	 * - When set, the user should be responsible for inserting the hairpin
1264 	 *   Tx part flows and removing them.
1265 	 * - When clear, the PMD will try to handle the Tx part of the flows,
1266 	 *   e.g., by splitting one flow into two parts.
1267 	 */
1268 	uint32_t tx_explicit:1;
1269 
1270 	/**
1271 	 * Manually bind hairpin queues.
1272 	 * One hairpin pair of queues should have the same attribute.
1273 	 *
1274 	 * - When set, to enable hairpin, the user should call the hairpin bind
1275 	 *   function after all the queues are set up properly and the ports are
1276 	 *   started. Also, the hairpin unbind function should be called
1277 	 *   accordingly before stopping a port that with hairpin configured.
1278 	 * - When cleared, the PMD will try to enable the hairpin with the queues
1279 	 *   configured automatically during port start.
1280 	 */
1281 	uint32_t manual_bind:1;
1282 
1283 	/**
1284 	 * Use locked device memory as a backing storage.
1285 	 *
1286 	 * - When set, PMD will attempt place descriptors and/or data buffers
1287 	 *   in dedicated device memory.
1288 	 * - When cleared, PMD will use default memory type as a backing storage.
1289 	 *   Please refer to PMD documentation for details.
1290 	 *
1291 	 * API user should check if PMD supports this configuration flag using
1292 	 * @see rte_eth_dev_hairpin_capability_get.
1293 	 */
1294 	uint32_t use_locked_device_memory:1;
1295 
1296 	/**
1297 	 * Use DPDK memory as backing storage.
1298 	 *
1299 	 * - When set, PMD will attempt place descriptors and/or data buffers
1300 	 *   in host memory managed by DPDK.
1301 	 * - When cleared, PMD will use default memory type as a backing storage.
1302 	 *   Please refer to PMD documentation for details.
1303 	 *
1304 	 * API user should check if PMD supports this configuration flag using
1305 	 * @see rte_eth_dev_hairpin_capability_get.
1306 	 */
1307 	uint32_t use_rte_memory:1;
1308 
1309 	/**
1310 	 * Force usage of hairpin memory configuration.
1311 	 *
1312 	 * - When set, PMD will attempt to use specified memory settings.
1313 	 *   If resource allocation fails, then hairpin queue allocation
1314 	 *   will result in an error.
1315 	 * - When clear, PMD will attempt to use specified memory settings.
1316 	 *   If resource allocation fails, then PMD will retry
1317 	 *   allocation with default configuration.
1318 	 */
1319 	uint32_t force_memory:1;
1320 
1321 	uint32_t reserved:11; /**< Reserved bits. */
1322 
1323 	struct rte_eth_hairpin_peer peers[RTE_ETH_MAX_HAIRPIN_PEERS];
1324 };
1325 
1326 /**
1327  * A structure contains information about HW descriptor ring limitations.
1328  */
1329 struct rte_eth_desc_lim {
1330 	uint16_t nb_max;   /**< Max allowed number of descriptors. */
1331 	uint16_t nb_min;   /**< Min allowed number of descriptors. */
1332 	uint16_t nb_align; /**< Number of descriptors should be aligned to. */
1333 
1334 	/**
1335 	 * Max allowed number of segments per whole packet.
1336 	 *
1337 	 * - For TSO packet this is the total number of data descriptors allowed
1338 	 *   by device.
1339 	 *
1340 	 * @see nb_mtu_seg_max
1341 	 */
1342 	uint16_t nb_seg_max;
1343 
1344 	/**
1345 	 * Max number of segments per one MTU.
1346 	 *
1347 	 * - For non-TSO packet, this is the maximum allowed number of segments
1348 	 *   in a single transmit packet.
1349 	 *
1350 	 * - For TSO packet each segment within the TSO may span up to this
1351 	 *   value.
1352 	 *
1353 	 * @see nb_seg_max
1354 	 */
1355 	uint16_t nb_mtu_seg_max;
1356 };
1357 
1358 /**
1359  * This enum indicates the flow control mode
1360  */
1361 enum rte_eth_fc_mode {
1362 	RTE_ETH_FC_NONE = 0, /**< Disable flow control. */
1363 	RTE_ETH_FC_RX_PAUSE, /**< Rx pause frame, enable flowctrl on Tx side. */
1364 	RTE_ETH_FC_TX_PAUSE, /**< Tx pause frame, enable flowctrl on Rx side. */
1365 	RTE_ETH_FC_FULL      /**< Enable flow control on both side. */
1366 };
1367 
1368 /**
1369  * A structure used to configure Ethernet flow control parameter.
1370  * These parameters will be configured into the register of the NIC.
1371  * Please refer to the corresponding data sheet for proper value.
1372  */
1373 struct rte_eth_fc_conf {
1374 	uint32_t high_water;  /**< High threshold value to trigger XOFF */
1375 	uint32_t low_water;   /**< Low threshold value to trigger XON */
1376 	uint16_t pause_time;  /**< Pause quota in the Pause frame */
1377 	uint16_t send_xon;    /**< Is XON frame need be sent */
1378 	enum rte_eth_fc_mode mode;  /**< Link flow control mode */
1379 	uint8_t mac_ctrl_frame_fwd; /**< Forward MAC control frames */
1380 	uint8_t autoneg;      /**< Use Pause autoneg */
1381 };
1382 
1383 /**
1384  * A structure used to configure Ethernet priority flow control parameter.
1385  * These parameters will be configured into the register of the NIC.
1386  * Please refer to the corresponding data sheet for proper value.
1387  */
1388 struct rte_eth_pfc_conf {
1389 	struct rte_eth_fc_conf fc; /**< General flow control parameter. */
1390 	uint8_t priority;          /**< VLAN User Priority. */
1391 };
1392 
1393 /**
1394  * @warning
1395  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
1396  *
1397  * A structure used to retrieve information of queue based PFC.
1398  */
1399 struct rte_eth_pfc_queue_info {
1400 	/**
1401 	 * Maximum supported traffic class as per PFC (802.1Qbb) specification.
1402 	 */
1403 	uint8_t tc_max;
1404 	/** PFC queue mode capabilities. */
1405 	enum rte_eth_fc_mode mode_capa;
1406 };
1407 
1408 /**
1409  * @warning
1410  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
1411  *
1412  * A structure used to configure Ethernet priority flow control parameters for
1413  * ethdev queues.
1414  *
1415  * rte_eth_pfc_queue_conf::rx_pause structure shall be used to configure given
1416  * tx_qid with corresponding tc. When ethdev device receives PFC frame with
1417  * rte_eth_pfc_queue_conf::rx_pause::tc, traffic will be paused on
1418  * rte_eth_pfc_queue_conf::rx_pause::tx_qid for that tc.
1419  *
1420  * rte_eth_pfc_queue_conf::tx_pause structure shall be used to configure given
1421  * rx_qid. When rx_qid is congested, PFC frames are generated with
1422  * rte_eth_pfc_queue_conf::rx_pause::tc and
1423  * rte_eth_pfc_queue_conf::rx_pause::pause_time to the peer.
1424  */
1425 struct rte_eth_pfc_queue_conf {
1426 	enum rte_eth_fc_mode mode; /**< Link flow control mode */
1427 
1428 	struct {
1429 		uint16_t tx_qid; /**< Tx queue ID */
1430 		/** Traffic class as per PFC (802.1Qbb) spec. The value must be
1431 		 * in the range [0, rte_eth_pfc_queue_info::tx_max - 1]
1432 		 */
1433 		uint8_t tc;
1434 	} rx_pause; /* Valid when (mode == FC_RX_PAUSE || mode == FC_FULL) */
1435 
1436 	struct {
1437 		uint16_t pause_time; /**< Pause quota in the Pause frame */
1438 		uint16_t rx_qid;     /**< Rx queue ID */
1439 		/** Traffic class as per PFC (802.1Qbb) spec. The value must be
1440 		 * in the range [0, rte_eth_pfc_queue_info::tx_max - 1]
1441 		 */
1442 		uint8_t tc;
1443 	} tx_pause; /* Valid when (mode == FC_TX_PAUSE || mode == FC_FULL) */
1444 };
1445 
1446 /**
1447  * Tunnel type for device-specific classifier configuration.
1448  * @see rte_eth_udp_tunnel
1449  */
1450 enum rte_eth_tunnel_type {
1451 	RTE_ETH_TUNNEL_TYPE_NONE = 0,
1452 	RTE_ETH_TUNNEL_TYPE_VXLAN,
1453 	RTE_ETH_TUNNEL_TYPE_GENEVE,
1454 	RTE_ETH_TUNNEL_TYPE_TEREDO,
1455 	RTE_ETH_TUNNEL_TYPE_NVGRE,
1456 	RTE_ETH_TUNNEL_TYPE_IP_IN_GRE,
1457 	RTE_ETH_L2_TUNNEL_TYPE_E_TAG,
1458 	RTE_ETH_TUNNEL_TYPE_VXLAN_GPE,
1459 	RTE_ETH_TUNNEL_TYPE_ECPRI,
1460 	RTE_ETH_TUNNEL_TYPE_MAX,
1461 };
1462 
1463 /* Deprecated API file for rte_eth_dev_filter_* functions */
1464 #include "rte_eth_ctrl.h"
1465 
1466 /**
1467  * UDP tunneling configuration.
1468  *
1469  * Used to configure the classifier of a device,
1470  * associating an UDP port with a type of tunnel.
1471  *
1472  * Some NICs may need such configuration to properly parse a tunnel
1473  * with any standard or custom UDP port.
1474  */
1475 struct rte_eth_udp_tunnel {
1476 	uint16_t udp_port; /**< UDP port used for the tunnel. */
1477 	uint8_t prot_type; /**< Tunnel type. @see rte_eth_tunnel_type */
1478 };
1479 
1480 /**
1481  * A structure used to enable/disable specific device interrupts.
1482  */
1483 struct rte_eth_intr_conf {
1484 	/** enable/disable lsc interrupt. 0 (default) - disable, 1 enable */
1485 	uint32_t lsc:1;
1486 	/** enable/disable rxq interrupt. 0 (default) - disable, 1 enable */
1487 	uint32_t rxq:1;
1488 	/** enable/disable rmv interrupt. 0 (default) - disable, 1 enable */
1489 	uint32_t rmv:1;
1490 };
1491 
1492 #define rte_intr_conf rte_eth_intr_conf
1493 
1494 /**
1495  * A structure used to configure an Ethernet port.
1496  * Depending upon the Rx multi-queue mode, extra advanced
1497  * configuration settings may be needed.
1498  */
1499 struct rte_eth_conf {
1500 	uint32_t link_speeds; /**< bitmap of RTE_ETH_LINK_SPEED_XXX of speeds to be
1501 				used. RTE_ETH_LINK_SPEED_FIXED disables link
1502 				autonegotiation, and a unique speed shall be
1503 				set. Otherwise, the bitmap defines the set of
1504 				speeds to be advertised. If the special value
1505 				RTE_ETH_LINK_SPEED_AUTONEG (0) is used, all speeds
1506 				supported are advertised. */
1507 	struct rte_eth_rxmode rxmode; /**< Port Rx configuration. */
1508 	struct rte_eth_txmode txmode; /**< Port Tx configuration. */
1509 	uint32_t lpbk_mode; /**< Loopback operation mode. By default the value
1510 			         is 0, meaning the loopback mode is disabled.
1511 				 Read the datasheet of given Ethernet controller
1512 				 for details. The possible values of this field
1513 				 are defined in implementation of each driver. */
1514 	struct {
1515 		struct rte_eth_rss_conf rss_conf; /**< Port RSS configuration */
1516 		/** Port VMDq+DCB configuration. */
1517 		struct rte_eth_vmdq_dcb_conf vmdq_dcb_conf;
1518 		/** Port DCB Rx configuration. */
1519 		struct rte_eth_dcb_rx_conf dcb_rx_conf;
1520 		/** Port VMDq Rx configuration. */
1521 		struct rte_eth_vmdq_rx_conf vmdq_rx_conf;
1522 	} rx_adv_conf; /**< Port Rx filtering configuration. */
1523 	union {
1524 		/** Port VMDq+DCB Tx configuration. */
1525 		struct rte_eth_vmdq_dcb_tx_conf vmdq_dcb_tx_conf;
1526 		/** Port DCB Tx configuration. */
1527 		struct rte_eth_dcb_tx_conf dcb_tx_conf;
1528 		/** Port VMDq Tx configuration. */
1529 		struct rte_eth_vmdq_tx_conf vmdq_tx_conf;
1530 	} tx_adv_conf; /**< Port Tx DCB configuration (union). */
1531 	/** Currently,Priority Flow Control(PFC) are supported,if DCB with PFC
1532 	    is needed,and the variable must be set RTE_ETH_DCB_PFC_SUPPORT. */
1533 	uint32_t dcb_capability_en;
1534 	struct rte_eth_intr_conf intr_conf; /**< Interrupt mode configuration. */
1535 };
1536 
1537 /**
1538  * Rx offload capabilities of a device.
1539  */
1540 #define RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_VLAN_STRIP       RTE_BIT64(0)
1541 #define RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_IPV4_CKSUM       RTE_BIT64(1)
1542 #define RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_UDP_CKSUM        RTE_BIT64(2)
1543 #define RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_TCP_CKSUM        RTE_BIT64(3)
1544 #define RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_TCP_LRO          RTE_BIT64(4)
1545 #define RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_QINQ_STRIP       RTE_BIT64(5)
1546 #define RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_OUTER_IPV4_CKSUM RTE_BIT64(6)
1547 #define RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_MACSEC_STRIP     RTE_BIT64(7)
1548 #define RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_VLAN_FILTER      RTE_BIT64(9)
1549 #define RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_VLAN_EXTEND      RTE_BIT64(10)
1550 #define RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_SCATTER          RTE_BIT64(13)
1551 /**
1552  * Timestamp is set by the driver in RTE_MBUF_DYNFIELD_TIMESTAMP_NAME
1553  * and RTE_MBUF_DYNFLAG_RX_TIMESTAMP_NAME is set in ol_flags.
1554  * The mbuf field and flag are registered when the offload is configured.
1555  */
1556 #define RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_TIMESTAMP        RTE_BIT64(14)
1557 #define RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_SECURITY         RTE_BIT64(15)
1558 #define RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_KEEP_CRC         RTE_BIT64(16)
1559 #define RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_SCTP_CKSUM       RTE_BIT64(17)
1560 #define RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_OUTER_UDP_CKSUM  RTE_BIT64(18)
1561 #define RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_RSS_HASH         RTE_BIT64(19)
1562 #define RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_BUFFER_SPLIT     RTE_BIT64(20)
1563 
1564 #define RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_CHECKSUM (RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_IPV4_CKSUM | \
1565 				 RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_UDP_CKSUM | \
1566 				 RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_TCP_CKSUM)
1567 #define RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_VLAN (RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_VLAN_STRIP | \
1568 			     RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_VLAN_FILTER | \
1569 			     RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_VLAN_EXTEND | \
1570 			     RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_QINQ_STRIP)
1571 
1572 /*
1573  * If new Rx offload capabilities are defined, they also must be
1574  * mentioned in rte_rx_offload_names in rte_ethdev.c file.
1575  */
1576 
1577 /**
1578  * Tx offload capabilities of a device.
1579  */
1580 #define RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_VLAN_INSERT      RTE_BIT64(0)
1581 #define RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_IPV4_CKSUM       RTE_BIT64(1)
1582 #define RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_UDP_CKSUM        RTE_BIT64(2)
1583 #define RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_TCP_CKSUM        RTE_BIT64(3)
1584 #define RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_SCTP_CKSUM       RTE_BIT64(4)
1585 #define RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_TCP_TSO          RTE_BIT64(5)
1586 #define RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_UDP_TSO          RTE_BIT64(6)
1587 #define RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_OUTER_IPV4_CKSUM RTE_BIT64(7)  /**< Used for tunneling packet. */
1588 #define RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_QINQ_INSERT      RTE_BIT64(8)
1589 #define RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_VXLAN_TNL_TSO    RTE_BIT64(9)  /**< Used for tunneling packet. */
1590 #define RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_GRE_TNL_TSO      RTE_BIT64(10) /**< Used for tunneling packet. */
1591 #define RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_IPIP_TNL_TSO     RTE_BIT64(11) /**< Used for tunneling packet. */
1592 #define RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_GENEVE_TNL_TSO   RTE_BIT64(12) /**< Used for tunneling packet. */
1593 #define RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_MACSEC_INSERT    RTE_BIT64(13)
1594 /**
1595  * Multiple threads can invoke rte_eth_tx_burst() concurrently on the same
1596  * Tx queue without SW lock.
1597  */
1598 #define RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_MT_LOCKFREE      RTE_BIT64(14)
1599 /** Device supports multi segment send. */
1600 #define RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_MULTI_SEGS       RTE_BIT64(15)
1601 /**
1602  * Device supports optimization for fast release of mbufs.
1603  * When set application must guarantee that per-queue all mbufs comes from
1604  * the same mempool and has refcnt = 1.
1605  */
1606 #define RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_MBUF_FAST_FREE   RTE_BIT64(16)
1607 #define RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_SECURITY         RTE_BIT64(17)
1608 /**
1609  * Device supports generic UDP tunneled packet TSO.
1610  * Application must set RTE_MBUF_F_TX_TUNNEL_UDP and other mbuf fields required
1611  * for tunnel TSO.
1612  */
1613 #define RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_UDP_TNL_TSO      RTE_BIT64(18)
1614 /**
1615  * Device supports generic IP tunneled packet TSO.
1616  * Application must set RTE_MBUF_F_TX_TUNNEL_IP and other mbuf fields required
1617  * for tunnel TSO.
1618  */
1619 #define RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_IP_TNL_TSO       RTE_BIT64(19)
1620 /** Device supports outer UDP checksum */
1621 #define RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_OUTER_UDP_CKSUM  RTE_BIT64(20)
1622 /**
1623  * Device sends on time read from RTE_MBUF_DYNFIELD_TIMESTAMP_NAME
1624  * if RTE_MBUF_DYNFLAG_TX_TIMESTAMP_NAME is set in ol_flags.
1625  * The mbuf field and flag are registered when the offload is configured.
1626  */
1627 #define RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_SEND_ON_TIMESTAMP RTE_BIT64(21)
1628 /*
1629  * If new Tx offload capabilities are defined, they also must be
1630  * mentioned in rte_tx_offload_names in rte_ethdev.c file.
1631  */
1632 
1633 /**@{@name Device capabilities
1634  * Non-offload capabilities reported in rte_eth_dev_info.dev_capa.
1635  */
1636 /** Device supports Rx queue setup after device started. */
1637 #define RTE_ETH_DEV_CAPA_RUNTIME_RX_QUEUE_SETUP RTE_BIT64(0)
1638 /** Device supports Tx queue setup after device started. */
1639 #define RTE_ETH_DEV_CAPA_RUNTIME_TX_QUEUE_SETUP RTE_BIT64(1)
1640 /**
1641  * Device supports shared Rx queue among ports within Rx domain and
1642  * switch domain. Mbufs are consumed by shared Rx queue instead of
1643  * each queue. Multiple groups are supported by share_group of Rx
1644  * queue configuration. Shared Rx queue is identified by PMD using
1645  * share_qid of Rx queue configuration. Polling any port in the group
1646  * receive packets of all member ports, source port identified by
1647  * mbuf->port field.
1648  */
1649 #define RTE_ETH_DEV_CAPA_RXQ_SHARE              RTE_BIT64(2)
1650 /** Device supports keeping flow rules across restart. */
1651 #define RTE_ETH_DEV_CAPA_FLOW_RULE_KEEP         RTE_BIT64(3)
1652 /** Device supports keeping shared flow objects across restart. */
1653 #define RTE_ETH_DEV_CAPA_FLOW_SHARED_OBJECT_KEEP RTE_BIT64(4)
1654 /**@}*/
1655 
1656 /*
1657  * Fallback default preferred Rx/Tx port parameters.
1658  * These are used if an application requests default parameters
1659  * but the PMD does not provide preferred values.
1660  */
1661 #define RTE_ETH_DEV_FALLBACK_RX_RINGSIZE 512
1662 #define RTE_ETH_DEV_FALLBACK_TX_RINGSIZE 512
1663 #define RTE_ETH_DEV_FALLBACK_RX_NBQUEUES 1
1664 #define RTE_ETH_DEV_FALLBACK_TX_NBQUEUES 1
1665 
1666 /**
1667  * Preferred Rx/Tx port parameters.
1668  * There are separate instances of this structure for transmission
1669  * and reception respectively.
1670  */
1671 struct rte_eth_dev_portconf {
1672 	uint16_t burst_size; /**< Device-preferred burst size */
1673 	uint16_t ring_size; /**< Device-preferred size of queue rings */
1674 	uint16_t nb_queues; /**< Device-preferred number of queues */
1675 };
1676 
1677 /**
1678  * Default values for switch domain ID when ethdev does not support switch
1679  * domain definitions.
1680  */
1681 #define RTE_ETH_DEV_SWITCH_DOMAIN_ID_INVALID	(UINT16_MAX)
1682 
1683 /**
1684  * Ethernet device associated switch information
1685  */
1686 struct rte_eth_switch_info {
1687 	const char *name;	/**< switch name */
1688 	uint16_t domain_id;	/**< switch domain ID */
1689 	/**
1690 	 * Mapping to the devices physical switch port as enumerated from the
1691 	 * perspective of the embedded interconnect/switch. For SR-IOV enabled
1692 	 * device this may correspond to the VF_ID of each virtual function,
1693 	 * but each driver should explicitly define the mapping of switch
1694 	 * port identifier to that physical interconnect/switch
1695 	 */
1696 	uint16_t port_id;
1697 	/**
1698 	 * Shared Rx queue sub-domain boundary. Only ports in same Rx domain
1699 	 * and switch domain can share Rx queue. Valid only if device advertised
1700 	 * RTE_ETH_DEV_CAPA_RXQ_SHARE capability.
1701 	 */
1702 	uint16_t rx_domain;
1703 };
1704 
1705 /**
1706  * @warning
1707  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this structure may change without prior notice.
1708  *
1709  * Ethernet device Rx buffer segmentation capabilities.
1710  */
1711 struct rte_eth_rxseg_capa {
1712 	__extension__
1713 	uint32_t multi_pools:1; /**< Supports receiving to multiple pools.*/
1714 	uint32_t offset_allowed:1; /**< Supports buffer offsets. */
1715 	uint32_t offset_align_log2:4; /**< Required offset alignment. */
1716 	uint16_t max_nseg; /**< Maximum amount of segments to split. */
1717 	uint16_t reserved; /**< Reserved field. */
1718 };
1719 
1720 /**
1721  * Ethernet device information
1722  */
1723 
1724 /**
1725  * Ethernet device representor port type.
1726  */
1727 enum rte_eth_representor_type {
1728 	RTE_ETH_REPRESENTOR_NONE, /**< not a representor. */
1729 	RTE_ETH_REPRESENTOR_VF,   /**< representor of Virtual Function. */
1730 	RTE_ETH_REPRESENTOR_SF,   /**< representor of Sub Function. */
1731 	RTE_ETH_REPRESENTOR_PF,   /**< representor of Physical Function. */
1732 };
1733 
1734 /**
1735  * @warning
1736  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this enumeration may change without prior notice.
1737  *
1738  * Ethernet device error handling mode.
1739  */
1740 enum rte_eth_err_handle_mode {
1741 	/** No error handling modes are supported. */
1742 	RTE_ETH_ERROR_HANDLE_MODE_NONE,
1743 	/** Passive error handling, after the PMD detects that a reset is required,
1744 	 * the PMD reports @see RTE_ETH_EVENT_INTR_RESET event,
1745 	 * and the application invokes @see rte_eth_dev_reset to recover the port.
1746 	 */
1747 	RTE_ETH_ERROR_HANDLE_MODE_PASSIVE,
1748 	/** Proactive error handling, after the PMD detects that a reset is required,
1749 	 * the PMD reports @see RTE_ETH_EVENT_ERR_RECOVERING event,
1750 	 * do recovery internally, and finally reports the recovery result event
1751 	 * (@see RTE_ETH_EVENT_RECOVERY_*).
1752 	 */
1753 	RTE_ETH_ERROR_HANDLE_MODE_PROACTIVE,
1754 };
1755 
1756 /**
1757  * A structure used to retrieve the contextual information of
1758  * an Ethernet device, such as the controlling driver of the
1759  * device, etc...
1760  */
1761 struct rte_eth_dev_info {
1762 	struct rte_device *device; /**< Generic device information */
1763 	const char *driver_name; /**< Device Driver name. */
1764 	unsigned int if_index; /**< Index to bound host interface, or 0 if none.
1765 		Use if_indextoname() to translate into an interface name. */
1766 	uint16_t min_mtu;	/**< Minimum MTU allowed */
1767 	uint16_t max_mtu;	/**< Maximum MTU allowed */
1768 	const uint32_t *dev_flags; /**< Device flags */
1769 	/** Minimum Rx buffer size per descriptor supported by HW. */
1770 	uint32_t min_rx_bufsize;
1771 	/**
1772 	 * Maximum Rx buffer size per descriptor supported by HW.
1773 	 * The value is not enforced, information only to application to
1774 	 * optimize mbuf size.
1775 	 * Its value is UINT32_MAX when not specified by the driver.
1776 	 */
1777 	uint32_t max_rx_bufsize;
1778 	uint32_t max_rx_pktlen; /**< Maximum configurable length of Rx pkt. */
1779 	/** Maximum configurable size of LRO aggregated packet. */
1780 	uint32_t max_lro_pkt_size;
1781 	uint16_t max_rx_queues; /**< Maximum number of Rx queues. */
1782 	uint16_t max_tx_queues; /**< Maximum number of Tx queues. */
1783 	uint32_t max_mac_addrs; /**< Maximum number of MAC addresses. */
1784 	/** Maximum number of hash MAC addresses for MTA and UTA. */
1785 	uint32_t max_hash_mac_addrs;
1786 	uint16_t max_vfs; /**< Maximum number of VFs. */
1787 	uint16_t max_vmdq_pools; /**< Maximum number of VMDq pools. */
1788 	struct rte_eth_rxseg_capa rx_seg_capa; /**< Segmentation capability.*/
1789 	/** All Rx offload capabilities including all per-queue ones */
1790 	uint64_t rx_offload_capa;
1791 	/** All Tx offload capabilities including all per-queue ones */
1792 	uint64_t tx_offload_capa;
1793 	/** Device per-queue Rx offload capabilities. */
1794 	uint64_t rx_queue_offload_capa;
1795 	/** Device per-queue Tx offload capabilities. */
1796 	uint64_t tx_queue_offload_capa;
1797 	/** Device redirection table size, the total number of entries. */
1798 	uint16_t reta_size;
1799 	uint8_t hash_key_size; /**< Hash key size in bytes */
1800 	uint32_t rss_algo_capa; /** RSS hash algorithms capabilities */
1801 	/** Bit mask of RSS offloads, the bit offset also means flow type */
1802 	uint64_t flow_type_rss_offloads;
1803 	struct rte_eth_rxconf default_rxconf; /**< Default Rx configuration */
1804 	struct rte_eth_txconf default_txconf; /**< Default Tx configuration */
1805 	uint16_t vmdq_queue_base; /**< First queue ID for VMDq pools. */
1806 	uint16_t vmdq_queue_num;  /**< Queue number for VMDq pools. */
1807 	uint16_t vmdq_pool_base;  /**< First ID of VMDq pools. */
1808 	struct rte_eth_desc_lim rx_desc_lim;  /**< Rx descriptors limits */
1809 	struct rte_eth_desc_lim tx_desc_lim;  /**< Tx descriptors limits */
1810 	uint32_t speed_capa;  /**< Supported speeds bitmap (RTE_ETH_LINK_SPEED_). */
1811 	/** Configured number of Rx/Tx queues */
1812 	uint16_t nb_rx_queues; /**< Number of Rx queues. */
1813 	uint16_t nb_tx_queues; /**< Number of Tx queues. */
1814 	/**
1815 	 * Maximum number of Rx mempools supported per Rx queue.
1816 	 *
1817 	 * Value greater than 0 means that the driver supports Rx queue
1818 	 * mempools specification via rx_conf->rx_mempools.
1819 	 */
1820 	uint16_t max_rx_mempools;
1821 	/** Rx parameter recommendations */
1822 	struct rte_eth_dev_portconf default_rxportconf;
1823 	/** Tx parameter recommendations */
1824 	struct rte_eth_dev_portconf default_txportconf;
1825 	/** Generic device capabilities (RTE_ETH_DEV_CAPA_). */
1826 	uint64_t dev_capa;
1827 	/**
1828 	 * Switching information for ports on a device with a
1829 	 * embedded managed interconnect/switch.
1830 	 */
1831 	struct rte_eth_switch_info switch_info;
1832 	/** Supported error handling mode. */
1833 	enum rte_eth_err_handle_mode err_handle_mode;
1834 
1835 	uint64_t reserved_64s[2]; /**< Reserved for future fields */
1836 	void *reserved_ptrs[2];   /**< Reserved for future fields */
1837 };
1838 
1839 /**@{@name Rx/Tx queue states */
1840 #define RTE_ETH_QUEUE_STATE_STOPPED 0 /**< Queue stopped. */
1841 #define RTE_ETH_QUEUE_STATE_STARTED 1 /**< Queue started. */
1842 #define RTE_ETH_QUEUE_STATE_HAIRPIN 2 /**< Queue used for hairpin. */
1843 /**@}*/
1844 
1845 /**
1846  * Ethernet device Rx queue information structure.
1847  * Used to retrieve information about configured queue.
1848  */
1849 struct __rte_cache_min_aligned rte_eth_rxq_info {
1850 	struct rte_mempool *mp;     /**< mempool used by that queue. */
1851 	struct rte_eth_rxconf conf; /**< queue config parameters. */
1852 	uint8_t scattered_rx;       /**< scattered packets Rx supported. */
1853 	uint8_t queue_state;        /**< one of RTE_ETH_QUEUE_STATE_*. */
1854 	uint16_t nb_desc;           /**< configured number of RXDs. */
1855 	uint16_t rx_buf_size;       /**< hardware receive buffer size. */
1856 	/**
1857 	 * Available Rx descriptors threshold defined as percentage
1858 	 * of Rx queue size. If number of available descriptors is lower,
1859 	 * the event RTE_ETH_EVENT_RX_AVAIL_THESH is generated.
1860 	 * Value 0 means that the threshold monitoring is disabled.
1861 	 */
1862 	uint8_t avail_thresh;
1863 };
1864 
1865 /**
1866  * Ethernet device Tx queue information structure.
1867  * Used to retrieve information about configured queue.
1868  */
1869 struct __rte_cache_min_aligned rte_eth_txq_info {
1870 	struct rte_eth_txconf conf; /**< queue config parameters. */
1871 	uint16_t nb_desc;           /**< configured number of TXDs. */
1872 	uint8_t queue_state;        /**< one of RTE_ETH_QUEUE_STATE_*. */
1873 };
1874 
1875 /**
1876  * @warning
1877  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this structure may change without prior notice.
1878  *
1879  * Ethernet device Rx queue information structure for recycling mbufs.
1880  * Used to retrieve Rx queue information when Tx queue reusing mbufs and moving
1881  * them into Rx mbuf ring.
1882  */
1883 struct __rte_cache_min_aligned rte_eth_recycle_rxq_info {
1884 	struct rte_mbuf **mbuf_ring; /**< mbuf ring of Rx queue. */
1885 	struct rte_mempool *mp;     /**< mempool of Rx queue. */
1886 	uint16_t *refill_head;      /**< head of Rx queue refilling mbufs. */
1887 	uint16_t *receive_tail;     /**< tail of Rx queue receiving pkts. */
1888 	uint16_t mbuf_ring_size;     /**< configured number of mbuf ring size. */
1889 	/**
1890 	 * Requirement on mbuf refilling batch size of Rx mbuf ring.
1891 	 * For some PMD drivers, the number of Rx mbuf ring refilling mbufs
1892 	 * should be aligned with mbuf ring size, in order to simplify
1893 	 * ring wrapping around.
1894 	 * Value 0 means that PMD drivers have no requirement for this.
1895 	 */
1896 	uint16_t refill_requirement;
1897 };
1898 
1899 /* Generic Burst mode flag definition, values can be ORed. */
1900 
1901 /**
1902  * If the queues have different burst mode description, this bit will be set
1903  * by PMD, then the application can iterate to retrieve burst description for
1904  * all other queues.
1905  */
1906 #define RTE_ETH_BURST_FLAG_PER_QUEUE RTE_BIT64(0)
1907 
1908 /**
1909  * Ethernet device Rx/Tx queue packet burst mode information structure.
1910  * Used to retrieve information about packet burst mode setting.
1911  */
1912 struct rte_eth_burst_mode {
1913 	uint64_t flags; /**< The ORed values of RTE_ETH_BURST_FLAG_xxx */
1914 
1915 #define RTE_ETH_BURST_MODE_INFO_SIZE 1024 /**< Maximum size for information */
1916 	char info[RTE_ETH_BURST_MODE_INFO_SIZE]; /**< burst mode information */
1917 };
1918 
1919 /** Maximum name length for extended statistics counters */
1920 #define RTE_ETH_XSTATS_NAME_SIZE 64
1921 
1922 /**
1923  * An Ethernet device extended statistic structure
1924  *
1925  * This structure is used by rte_eth_xstats_get() to provide
1926  * statistics that are not provided in the generic *rte_eth_stats*
1927  * structure.
1928  * It maps a name ID, corresponding to an index in the array returned
1929  * by rte_eth_xstats_get_names(), to a statistic value.
1930  */
1931 struct rte_eth_xstat {
1932 	uint64_t id;        /**< The index in xstats name array. */
1933 	uint64_t value;     /**< The statistic counter value. */
1934 };
1935 
1936 /**
1937  * A name element for extended statistics.
1938  *
1939  * An array of this structure is returned by rte_eth_xstats_get_names().
1940  * It lists the names of extended statistics for a PMD. The *rte_eth_xstat*
1941  * structure references these names by their array index.
1942  *
1943  * The xstats should follow a common naming scheme.
1944  * Some names are standardized in rte_stats_strings.
1945  * Examples:
1946  *     - rx_missed_errors
1947  *     - tx_q3_bytes
1948  *     - tx_size_128_to_255_packets
1949  */
1950 struct rte_eth_xstat_name {
1951 	char name[RTE_ETH_XSTATS_NAME_SIZE]; /**< The statistic name. */
1952 };
1953 
1954 #define RTE_ETH_DCB_NUM_TCS    8
1955 #define RTE_ETH_MAX_VMDQ_POOL  64
1956 
1957 /**
1958  * A structure used to get the information of queue and
1959  * TC mapping on both Tx and Rx paths.
1960  */
1961 struct rte_eth_dcb_tc_queue_mapping {
1962 	/** Rx queues assigned to tc per Pool */
1963 	struct {
1964 		uint16_t base;
1965 		uint16_t nb_queue;
1966 	} tc_rxq[RTE_ETH_MAX_VMDQ_POOL][RTE_ETH_DCB_NUM_TCS];
1967 	/** Rx queues assigned to tc per Pool */
1968 	struct {
1969 		uint16_t base;
1970 		uint16_t nb_queue;
1971 	} tc_txq[RTE_ETH_MAX_VMDQ_POOL][RTE_ETH_DCB_NUM_TCS];
1972 };
1973 
1974 /**
1975  * A structure used to get the information of DCB.
1976  * It includes TC UP mapping and queue TC mapping.
1977  */
1978 struct rte_eth_dcb_info {
1979 	uint8_t nb_tcs;        /**< number of TCs */
1980 	uint8_t prio_tc[RTE_ETH_DCB_NUM_USER_PRIORITIES]; /**< Priority to tc */
1981 	uint8_t tc_bws[RTE_ETH_DCB_NUM_TCS]; /**< Tx BW percentage for each TC */
1982 	/** Rx queues assigned to tc */
1983 	struct rte_eth_dcb_tc_queue_mapping tc_queue;
1984 };
1985 
1986 /**
1987  * This enum indicates the possible Forward Error Correction (FEC) modes
1988  * of an ethdev port.
1989  */
1990 enum rte_eth_fec_mode {
1991 	RTE_ETH_FEC_NOFEC = 0,      /**< FEC is off */
1992 	RTE_ETH_FEC_AUTO,	    /**< FEC autonegotiation modes */
1993 	RTE_ETH_FEC_BASER,          /**< FEC using common algorithm */
1994 	RTE_ETH_FEC_RS,             /**< FEC using RS algorithm */
1995 	RTE_ETH_FEC_LLRS,           /**< FEC using LLRS algorithm */
1996 };
1997 
1998 /* Translate from FEC mode to FEC capa */
1999 #define RTE_ETH_FEC_MODE_TO_CAPA(x) RTE_BIT32(x)
2000 
2001 /* This macro indicates FEC capa mask */
2002 #define RTE_ETH_FEC_MODE_CAPA_MASK(x) RTE_BIT32(RTE_ETH_FEC_ ## x)
2003 
2004 /* A structure used to get capabilities per link speed */
2005 struct rte_eth_fec_capa {
2006 	uint32_t speed; /**< Link speed (see RTE_ETH_SPEED_NUM_*) */
2007 	uint32_t capa;  /**< FEC capabilities bitmask */
2008 };
2009 
2010 #define RTE_ETH_ALL RTE_MAX_ETHPORTS
2011 
2012 /* Macros to check for valid port */
2013 #define RTE_ETH_VALID_PORTID_OR_ERR_RET(port_id, retval) do { \
2014 	if (!rte_eth_dev_is_valid_port(port_id)) { \
2015 		RTE_ETHDEV_LOG_LINE(ERR, "Invalid port_id=%u", port_id); \
2016 		return retval; \
2017 	} \
2018 } while (0)
2019 
2020 #define RTE_ETH_VALID_PORTID_OR_RET(port_id) do { \
2021 	if (!rte_eth_dev_is_valid_port(port_id)) { \
2022 		RTE_ETHDEV_LOG_LINE(ERR, "Invalid port_id=%u", port_id); \
2023 		return; \
2024 	} \
2025 } while (0)
2026 
2027 /**
2028  * Function type used for Rx packet processing packet callbacks.
2029  *
2030  * The callback function is called on Rx with a burst of packets that have
2031  * been received on the given port and queue.
2032  *
2033  * @param port_id
2034  *   The Ethernet port on which Rx is being performed.
2035  * @param queue
2036  *   The queue on the Ethernet port which is being used to receive the packets.
2037  * @param pkts
2038  *   The burst of packets that have just been received.
2039  * @param nb_pkts
2040  *   The number of packets in the burst pointed to by "pkts".
2041  * @param max_pkts
2042  *   The max number of packets that can be stored in the "pkts" array.
2043  * @param user_param
2044  *   The arbitrary user parameter passed in by the application when the callback
2045  *   was originally configured.
2046  * @return
2047  *   The number of packets returned to the user.
2048  */
2049 typedef uint16_t (*rte_rx_callback_fn)(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue,
2050 	struct rte_mbuf *pkts[], uint16_t nb_pkts, uint16_t max_pkts,
2051 	void *user_param);
2052 
2053 /**
2054  * Function type used for Tx packet processing packet callbacks.
2055  *
2056  * The callback function is called on Tx with a burst of packets immediately
2057  * before the packets are put onto the hardware queue for transmission.
2058  *
2059  * @param port_id
2060  *   The Ethernet port on which Tx is being performed.
2061  * @param queue
2062  *   The queue on the Ethernet port which is being used to transmit the packets.
2063  * @param pkts
2064  *   The burst of packets that are about to be transmitted.
2065  * @param nb_pkts
2066  *   The number of packets in the burst pointed to by "pkts".
2067  * @param user_param
2068  *   The arbitrary user parameter passed in by the application when the callback
2069  *   was originally configured.
2070  * @return
2071  *   The number of packets to be written to the NIC.
2072  */
2073 typedef uint16_t (*rte_tx_callback_fn)(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue,
2074 	struct rte_mbuf *pkts[], uint16_t nb_pkts, void *user_param);
2075 
2076 /**
2077  * Possible states of an ethdev port.
2078  */
2079 enum rte_eth_dev_state {
2080 	/** Device is unused before being probed. */
2081 	RTE_ETH_DEV_UNUSED = 0,
2082 	/** Device is attached when allocated in probing. */
2083 	RTE_ETH_DEV_ATTACHED,
2084 	/** Device is in removed state when plug-out is detected. */
2085 	RTE_ETH_DEV_REMOVED,
2086 };
2087 
2088 struct rte_eth_dev_sriov {
2089 	uint8_t active;               /**< SRIOV is active with 16, 32 or 64 pools */
2090 	uint8_t nb_q_per_pool;        /**< Rx queue number per pool */
2091 	uint16_t def_vmdq_idx;        /**< Default pool num used for PF */
2092 	uint16_t def_pool_q_idx;      /**< Default pool queue start reg index */
2093 };
2094 #define RTE_ETH_DEV_SRIOV(dev)         ((dev)->data->sriov)
2095 
2096 #define RTE_ETH_NAME_MAX_LEN RTE_DEV_NAME_MAX_LEN
2097 
2098 #define RTE_ETH_DEV_NO_OWNER 0
2099 
2100 #define RTE_ETH_MAX_OWNER_NAME_LEN 64
2101 
2102 struct rte_eth_dev_owner {
2103 	uint64_t id; /**< The owner unique identifier. */
2104 	char name[RTE_ETH_MAX_OWNER_NAME_LEN]; /**< The owner name. */
2105 };
2106 
2107 /**@{@name Device flags
2108  * Flags internally saved in rte_eth_dev_data.dev_flags
2109  * and reported in rte_eth_dev_info.dev_flags.
2110  */
2111 /** PMD supports thread-safe flow operations */
2112 #define RTE_ETH_DEV_FLOW_OPS_THREAD_SAFE  RTE_BIT32(0)
2113 /** Device supports link state interrupt */
2114 #define RTE_ETH_DEV_INTR_LSC              RTE_BIT32(1)
2115 /** Device is a bonding member */
2116 #define RTE_ETH_DEV_BONDING_MEMBER        RTE_BIT32(2)
2117 /** Device supports device removal interrupt */
2118 #define RTE_ETH_DEV_INTR_RMV              RTE_BIT32(3)
2119 /** Device is port representor */
2120 #define RTE_ETH_DEV_REPRESENTOR           RTE_BIT32(4)
2121 /** Device does not support MAC change after started */
2122 #define RTE_ETH_DEV_NOLIVE_MAC_ADDR       RTE_BIT32(5)
2123 /**
2124  * Queue xstats filled automatically by ethdev layer.
2125  * PMDs filling the queue xstats themselves should not set this flag
2126  */
2127 #define RTE_ETH_DEV_AUTOFILL_QUEUE_XSTATS RTE_BIT32(6)
2128 /**@}*/
2129 
2130 /**
2131  * Iterates over valid ethdev ports owned by a specific owner.
2132  *
2133  * @param port_id
2134  *   The ID of the next possible valid owned port.
2135  * @param	owner_id
2136  *  The owner identifier.
2137  *  RTE_ETH_DEV_NO_OWNER means iterate over all valid ownerless ports.
2138  * @return
2139  *   Next valid port ID owned by owner_id, RTE_MAX_ETHPORTS if there is none.
2140  */
2141 uint64_t rte_eth_find_next_owned_by(uint16_t port_id,
2142 		const uint64_t owner_id);
2143 
2144 /**
2145  * Macro to iterate over all enabled ethdev ports owned by a specific owner.
2146  */
2147 #define RTE_ETH_FOREACH_DEV_OWNED_BY(p, o) \
2148 	for (p = rte_eth_find_next_owned_by(0, o); \
2149 	     (unsigned int)p < (unsigned int)RTE_MAX_ETHPORTS; \
2150 	     p = rte_eth_find_next_owned_by(p + 1, o))
2151 
2152 /**
2153  * Iterates over valid ethdev ports.
2154  *
2155  * @param port_id
2156  *   The ID of the next possible valid port.
2157  * @return
2158  *   Next valid port ID, RTE_MAX_ETHPORTS if there is none.
2159  */
2160 uint16_t rte_eth_find_next(uint16_t port_id);
2161 
2162 /**
2163  * Macro to iterate over all enabled and ownerless ethdev ports.
2164  */
2165 #define RTE_ETH_FOREACH_DEV(p) \
2166 	RTE_ETH_FOREACH_DEV_OWNED_BY(p, RTE_ETH_DEV_NO_OWNER)
2167 
2168 /**
2169  * Iterates over ethdev ports of a specified device.
2170  *
2171  * @param port_id_start
2172  *   The ID of the next possible valid port.
2173  * @param parent
2174  *   The generic device behind the ports to iterate.
2175  * @return
2176  *   Next port ID of the device, possibly port_id_start,
2177  *   RTE_MAX_ETHPORTS if there is none.
2178  */
2179 uint16_t
2180 rte_eth_find_next_of(uint16_t port_id_start,
2181 		const struct rte_device *parent);
2182 
2183 /**
2184  * Macro to iterate over all ethdev ports of a specified device.
2185  *
2186  * @param port_id
2187  *   The ID of the matching port being iterated.
2188  * @param parent
2189  *   The rte_device pointer matching the iterated ports.
2190  */
2191 #define RTE_ETH_FOREACH_DEV_OF(port_id, parent) \
2192 	for (port_id = rte_eth_find_next_of(0, parent); \
2193 		port_id < RTE_MAX_ETHPORTS; \
2194 		port_id = rte_eth_find_next_of(port_id + 1, parent))
2195 
2196 /**
2197  * Iterates over sibling ethdev ports (i.e. sharing the same rte_device).
2198  *
2199  * @param port_id_start
2200  *   The ID of the next possible valid sibling port.
2201  * @param ref_port_id
2202  *   The ID of a reference port to compare rte_device with.
2203  * @return
2204  *   Next sibling port ID, possibly port_id_start or ref_port_id itself,
2205  *   RTE_MAX_ETHPORTS if there is none.
2206  */
2207 uint16_t
2208 rte_eth_find_next_sibling(uint16_t port_id_start, uint16_t ref_port_id);
2209 
2210 /**
2211  * Macro to iterate over all ethdev ports sharing the same rte_device
2212  * as the specified port.
2213  * Note: the specified reference port is part of the loop iterations.
2214  *
2215  * @param port_id
2216  *   The ID of the matching port being iterated.
2217  * @param ref_port_id
2218  *   The ID of the port being compared.
2219  */
2220 #define RTE_ETH_FOREACH_DEV_SIBLING(port_id, ref_port_id) \
2221 	for (port_id = rte_eth_find_next_sibling(0, ref_port_id); \
2222 		port_id < RTE_MAX_ETHPORTS; \
2223 		port_id = rte_eth_find_next_sibling(port_id + 1, ref_port_id))
2224 
2225 /**
2226  * Get a new unique owner identifier.
2227  * An owner identifier is used to owns Ethernet devices by only one DPDK entity
2228  * to avoid multiple management of device by different entities.
2229  *
2230  * @param	owner_id
2231  *   Owner identifier pointer.
2232  * @return
2233  *   Negative errno value on error, 0 on success.
2234  */
2235 int rte_eth_dev_owner_new(uint64_t *owner_id);
2236 
2237 /**
2238  * Set an Ethernet device owner.
2239  *
2240  * @param	port_id
2241  *  The identifier of the port to own.
2242  * @param	owner
2243  *  The owner pointer.
2244  * @return
2245  *  Negative errno value on error, 0 on success.
2246  */
2247 int rte_eth_dev_owner_set(const uint16_t port_id,
2248 		const struct rte_eth_dev_owner *owner);
2249 
2250 /**
2251  * Unset Ethernet device owner to make the device ownerless.
2252  *
2253  * @param	port_id
2254  *  The identifier of port to make ownerless.
2255  * @param	owner_id
2256  *  The owner identifier.
2257  * @return
2258  *  0 on success, negative errno value on error.
2259  */
2260 int rte_eth_dev_owner_unset(const uint16_t port_id,
2261 		const uint64_t owner_id);
2262 
2263 /**
2264  * Remove owner from all Ethernet devices owned by a specific owner.
2265  *
2266  * @param	owner_id
2267  *  The owner identifier.
2268  * @return
2269  *  0 on success, negative errno value on error.
2270  */
2271 int rte_eth_dev_owner_delete(const uint64_t owner_id);
2272 
2273 /**
2274  * Get the owner of an Ethernet device.
2275  *
2276  * @param	port_id
2277  *  The port identifier.
2278  * @param	owner
2279  *  The owner structure pointer to fill.
2280  * @return
2281  *  0 on success, negative errno value on error..
2282  */
2283 int rte_eth_dev_owner_get(const uint16_t port_id,
2284 		struct rte_eth_dev_owner *owner);
2285 
2286 /**
2287  * Get the number of ports which are usable for the application.
2288  *
2289  * These devices must be iterated by using the macro
2290  * ``RTE_ETH_FOREACH_DEV`` or ``RTE_ETH_FOREACH_DEV_OWNED_BY``
2291  * to deal with non-contiguous ranges of devices.
2292  *
2293  * @return
2294  *   The count of available Ethernet devices.
2295  */
2296 uint16_t rte_eth_dev_count_avail(void);
2297 
2298 /**
2299  * Get the total number of ports which are allocated.
2300  *
2301  * Some devices may not be available for the application.
2302  *
2303  * @return
2304  *   The total count of Ethernet devices.
2305  */
2306 uint16_t rte_eth_dev_count_total(void);
2307 
2308 /**
2309  * Convert a numerical speed in Mbps to a bitmap flag that can be used in
2310  * the bitmap link_speeds of the struct rte_eth_conf
2311  *
2312  * @param speed
2313  *   Numerical speed value in Mbps
2314  * @param duplex
2315  *   RTE_ETH_LINK_[HALF/FULL]_DUPLEX (only for 10/100M speeds)
2316  * @return
2317  *   0 if the speed cannot be mapped
2318  */
2319 uint32_t rte_eth_speed_bitflag(uint32_t speed, int duplex);
2320 
2321 /**
2322  * Get RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_* flag name.
2323  *
2324  * @param offload
2325  *   Offload flag.
2326  * @return
2327  *   Offload name or 'UNKNOWN' if the flag cannot be recognised.
2328  */
2329 const char *rte_eth_dev_rx_offload_name(uint64_t offload);
2330 
2331 /**
2332  * Get RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_* flag name.
2333  *
2334  * @param offload
2335  *   Offload flag.
2336  * @return
2337  *   Offload name or 'UNKNOWN' if the flag cannot be recognised.
2338  */
2339 const char *rte_eth_dev_tx_offload_name(uint64_t offload);
2340 
2341 /**
2342  * @warning
2343  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change without prior notice.
2344  *
2345  * Get RTE_ETH_DEV_CAPA_* flag name.
2346  *
2347  * @param capability
2348  *   Capability flag.
2349  * @return
2350  *   Capability name or 'UNKNOWN' if the flag cannot be recognized.
2351  */
2352 __rte_experimental
2353 const char *rte_eth_dev_capability_name(uint64_t capability);
2354 
2355 /**
2356  * Configure an Ethernet device.
2357  * This function must be invoked first before any other function in the
2358  * Ethernet API. This function can also be re-invoked when a device is in the
2359  * stopped state.
2360  *
2361  * @param port_id
2362  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device to configure.
2363  * @param nb_rx_queue
2364  *   The number of receive queues to set up for the Ethernet device.
2365  * @param nb_tx_queue
2366  *   The number of transmit queues to set up for the Ethernet device.
2367  * @param eth_conf
2368  *   The pointer to the configuration data to be used for the Ethernet device.
2369  *   The *rte_eth_conf* structure includes:
2370  *     -  the hardware offload features to activate, with dedicated fields for
2371  *        each statically configurable offload hardware feature provided by
2372  *        Ethernet devices, such as IP checksum or VLAN tag stripping for
2373  *        example.
2374  *        The Rx offload bitfield API is obsolete and will be deprecated.
2375  *        Applications should set the ignore_bitfield_offloads bit on *rxmode*
2376  *        structure and use offloads field to set per-port offloads instead.
2377  *     -  Any offloading set in eth_conf->[rt]xmode.offloads must be within
2378  *        the [rt]x_offload_capa returned from rte_eth_dev_info_get().
2379  *        Any type of device supported offloading set in the input argument
2380  *        eth_conf->[rt]xmode.offloads to rte_eth_dev_configure() is enabled
2381  *        on all queues and it can't be disabled in rte_eth_[rt]x_queue_setup()
2382  *     -  the Receive Side Scaling (RSS) configuration when using multiple Rx
2383  *        queues per port. Any RSS hash function set in eth_conf->rss_conf.rss_hf
2384  *        must be within the flow_type_rss_offloads provided by drivers via
2385  *        rte_eth_dev_info_get() API.
2386  *
2387  *   Embedding all configuration information in a single data structure
2388  *   is the more flexible method that allows the addition of new features
2389  *   without changing the syntax of the API.
2390  * @return
2391  *   - 0: Success, device configured.
2392  *   - <0: Error code returned by the driver configuration function.
2393  */
2394 int rte_eth_dev_configure(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t nb_rx_queue,
2395 		uint16_t nb_tx_queue, const struct rte_eth_conf *eth_conf);
2396 
2397 /**
2398  * Check if an Ethernet device was physically removed.
2399  *
2400  * @param port_id
2401  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
2402  * @return
2403  *   1 when the Ethernet device is removed, otherwise 0.
2404  */
2405 int
2406 rte_eth_dev_is_removed(uint16_t port_id);
2407 
2408 /**
2409  * Allocate and set up a receive queue for an Ethernet device.
2410  *
2411  * The function allocates a contiguous block of memory for *nb_rx_desc*
2412  * receive descriptors from a memory zone associated with *socket_id*
2413  * and initializes each receive descriptor with a network buffer allocated
2414  * from the memory pool *mb_pool*.
2415  *
2416  * @param port_id
2417  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
2418  * @param rx_queue_id
2419  *   The index of the receive queue to set up.
2420  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_rx_queue - 1] previously supplied
2421  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure().
2422  * @param nb_rx_desc
2423  *   The number of receive descriptors to allocate for the receive ring.
2424  * @param socket_id
2425  *   The *socket_id* argument is the socket identifier in case of NUMA.
2426  *   The value can be *SOCKET_ID_ANY* if there is no NUMA constraint for
2427  *   the DMA memory allocated for the receive descriptors of the ring.
2428  * @param rx_conf
2429  *   The pointer to the configuration data to be used for the receive queue.
2430  *   NULL value is allowed, in which case default Rx configuration
2431  *   will be used.
2432  *   The *rx_conf* structure contains an *rx_thresh* structure with the values
2433  *   of the Prefetch, Host, and Write-Back threshold registers of the receive
2434  *   ring.
2435  *   In addition it contains the hardware offloads features to activate using
2436  *   the RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_* flags.
2437  *   If an offloading set in rx_conf->offloads
2438  *   hasn't been set in the input argument eth_conf->rxmode.offloads
2439  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure(), it is a new added offloading, it must be
2440  *   per-queue type and it is enabled for the queue.
2441  *   No need to repeat any bit in rx_conf->offloads which has already been
2442  *   enabled in rte_eth_dev_configure() at port level. An offloading enabled
2443  *   at port level can't be disabled at queue level.
2444  *   The configuration structure also contains the pointer to the array
2445  *   of the receiving buffer segment descriptions, see rx_seg and rx_nseg
2446  *   fields, this extended configuration might be used by split offloads like
2447  *   RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_BUFFER_SPLIT. If mb_pool is not NULL,
2448  *   the extended configuration fields must be set to NULL and zero.
2449  * @param mb_pool
2450  *   The pointer to the memory pool from which to allocate *rte_mbuf* network
2451  *   memory buffers to populate each descriptor of the receive ring. There are
2452  *   two options to provide Rx buffer configuration:
2453  *   - single pool:
2454  *     mb_pool is not NULL, rx_conf.rx_nseg is 0.
2455  *   - multiple segments description:
2456  *     mb_pool is NULL, rx_conf.rx_seg is not NULL, rx_conf.rx_nseg is not 0.
2457  *     Taken only if flag RTE_ETH_RX_OFFLOAD_BUFFER_SPLIT is set in offloads.
2458  *
2459  * @return
2460  *   - 0: Success, receive queue correctly set up.
2461  *   - -EIO: if device is removed.
2462  *   - -ENODEV: if *port_id* is invalid.
2463  *   - -EINVAL: The memory pool pointer is null or the size of network buffers
2464  *      which can be allocated from this memory pool does not fit the various
2465  *      buffer sizes allowed by the device controller.
2466  *   - -ENOMEM: Unable to allocate the receive ring descriptors or to
2467  *      allocate network memory buffers from the memory pool when
2468  *      initializing receive descriptors.
2469  */
2470 int rte_eth_rx_queue_setup(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t rx_queue_id,
2471 		uint16_t nb_rx_desc, unsigned int socket_id,
2472 		const struct rte_eth_rxconf *rx_conf,
2473 		struct rte_mempool *mb_pool);
2474 
2475 /**
2476  * @warning
2477  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
2478  *
2479  * Allocate and set up a hairpin receive queue for an Ethernet device.
2480  *
2481  * The function set up the selected queue to be used in hairpin.
2482  *
2483  * @param port_id
2484  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
2485  * @param rx_queue_id
2486  *   The index of the receive queue to set up.
2487  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_rx_queue - 1] previously supplied
2488  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure().
2489  * @param nb_rx_desc
2490  *   The number of receive descriptors to allocate for the receive ring.
2491  *   0 means the PMD will use default value.
2492  * @param conf
2493  *   The pointer to the hairpin configuration.
2494  *
2495  * @return
2496  *   - (0) if successful.
2497  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* is invalid.
2498  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support.
2499  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
2500  *   - (-ENOMEM) if unable to allocate the resources.
2501  */
2502 __rte_experimental
2503 int rte_eth_rx_hairpin_queue_setup
2504 	(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t rx_queue_id, uint16_t nb_rx_desc,
2505 	 const struct rte_eth_hairpin_conf *conf);
2506 
2507 /**
2508  * Allocate and set up a transmit queue for an Ethernet device.
2509  *
2510  * @param port_id
2511  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
2512  * @param tx_queue_id
2513  *   The index of the transmit queue to set up.
2514  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_tx_queue - 1] previously supplied
2515  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure().
2516  * @param nb_tx_desc
2517  *   The number of transmit descriptors to allocate for the transmit ring.
2518  * @param socket_id
2519  *   The *socket_id* argument is the socket identifier in case of NUMA.
2520  *   Its value can be *SOCKET_ID_ANY* if there is no NUMA constraint for
2521  *   the DMA memory allocated for the transmit descriptors of the ring.
2522  * @param tx_conf
2523  *   The pointer to the configuration data to be used for the transmit queue.
2524  *   NULL value is allowed, in which case default Tx configuration
2525  *   will be used.
2526  *   The *tx_conf* structure contains the following data:
2527  *   - The *tx_thresh* structure with the values of the Prefetch, Host, and
2528  *     Write-Back threshold registers of the transmit ring.
2529  *     When setting Write-Back threshold to the value greater then zero,
2530  *     *tx_rs_thresh* value should be explicitly set to one.
2531  *   - The *tx_free_thresh* value indicates the [minimum] number of network
2532  *     buffers that must be pending in the transmit ring to trigger their
2533  *     [implicit] freeing by the driver transmit function.
2534  *   - The *tx_rs_thresh* value indicates the [minimum] number of transmit
2535  *     descriptors that must be pending in the transmit ring before setting the
2536  *     RS bit on a descriptor by the driver transmit function.
2537  *     The *tx_rs_thresh* value should be less or equal then
2538  *     *tx_free_thresh* value, and both of them should be less then
2539  *     *nb_tx_desc* - 3.
2540  *   - The *offloads* member contains Tx offloads to be enabled.
2541  *     If an offloading set in tx_conf->offloads
2542  *     hasn't been set in the input argument eth_conf->txmode.offloads
2543  *     to rte_eth_dev_configure(), it is a new added offloading, it must be
2544  *     per-queue type and it is enabled for the queue.
2545  *     No need to repeat any bit in tx_conf->offloads which has already been
2546  *     enabled in rte_eth_dev_configure() at port level. An offloading enabled
2547  *     at port level can't be disabled at queue level.
2548  *
2549  *     Note that setting *tx_free_thresh* or *tx_rs_thresh* value to 0 forces
2550  *     the transmit function to use default values.
2551  * @return
2552  *   - 0: Success, the transmit queue is correctly set up.
2553  *   - -ENOMEM: Unable to allocate the transmit ring descriptors.
2554  */
2555 int rte_eth_tx_queue_setup(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t tx_queue_id,
2556 		uint16_t nb_tx_desc, unsigned int socket_id,
2557 		const struct rte_eth_txconf *tx_conf);
2558 
2559 /**
2560  * @warning
2561  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
2562  *
2563  * Allocate and set up a transmit hairpin queue for an Ethernet device.
2564  *
2565  * @param port_id
2566  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
2567  * @param tx_queue_id
2568  *   The index of the transmit queue to set up.
2569  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_tx_queue - 1] previously supplied
2570  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure().
2571  * @param nb_tx_desc
2572  *   The number of transmit descriptors to allocate for the transmit ring.
2573  *   0 to set default PMD value.
2574  * @param conf
2575  *   The hairpin configuration.
2576  *
2577  * @return
2578  *   - (0) if successful.
2579  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* is invalid.
2580  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support.
2581  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
2582  *   - (-ENOMEM) if unable to allocate the resources.
2583  */
2584 __rte_experimental
2585 int rte_eth_tx_hairpin_queue_setup
2586 	(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t tx_queue_id, uint16_t nb_tx_desc,
2587 	 const struct rte_eth_hairpin_conf *conf);
2588 
2589 /**
2590  * @warning
2591  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
2592  *
2593  * Get all the hairpin peer Rx / Tx ports of the current port.
2594  * The caller should ensure that the array is large enough to save the ports
2595  * list.
2596  *
2597  * @param port_id
2598  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
2599  * @param peer_ports
2600  *   Pointer to the array to store the peer ports list.
2601  * @param len
2602  *   Length of the array to store the port identifiers.
2603  * @param direction
2604  *   Current port to peer port direction
2605  *   positive - current used as Tx to get all peer Rx ports.
2606  *   zero - current used as Rx to get all peer Tx ports.
2607  *
2608  * @return
2609  *   - (0 or positive) actual peer ports number.
2610  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
2611  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid
2612  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support.
2613  *   - Others detailed errors from PMDs.
2614  */
2615 __rte_experimental
2616 int rte_eth_hairpin_get_peer_ports(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t *peer_ports,
2617 				   size_t len, uint32_t direction);
2618 
2619 /**
2620  * @warning
2621  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
2622  *
2623  * Bind all hairpin Tx queues of one port to the Rx queues of the peer port.
2624  * It is only allowed to call this function after all hairpin queues are
2625  * configured properly and the devices are in started state.
2626  *
2627  * @param tx_port
2628  *   The identifier of the Tx port.
2629  * @param rx_port
2630  *   The identifier of peer Rx port.
2631  *   RTE_MAX_ETHPORTS is allowed for the traversal of all devices.
2632  *   Rx port ID could have the same value as Tx port ID.
2633  *
2634  * @return
2635  *   - (0) if successful.
2636  *   - (-ENODEV) if Tx port ID is invalid.
2637  *   - (-EBUSY) if device is not in started state.
2638  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support.
2639  *   - Others detailed errors from PMDs.
2640  */
2641 __rte_experimental
2642 int rte_eth_hairpin_bind(uint16_t tx_port, uint16_t rx_port);
2643 
2644 /**
2645  * @warning
2646  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
2647  *
2648  * Unbind all hairpin Tx queues of one port from the Rx queues of the peer port.
2649  * This should be called before closing the Tx or Rx devices, if the bind
2650  * function is called before.
2651  * After unbinding the hairpin ports pair, it is allowed to bind them again.
2652  * Changing queues configuration should be after stopping the device(s).
2653  *
2654  * @param tx_port
2655  *   The identifier of the Tx port.
2656  * @param rx_port
2657  *   The identifier of peer Rx port.
2658  *   RTE_MAX_ETHPORTS is allowed for traversal of all devices.
2659  *   Rx port ID could have the same value as Tx port ID.
2660  *
2661  * @return
2662  *   - (0) if successful.
2663  *   - (-ENODEV) if Tx port ID is invalid.
2664  *   - (-EBUSY) if device is in stopped state.
2665  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support.
2666  *   - Others detailed errors from PMDs.
2667  */
2668 __rte_experimental
2669 int rte_eth_hairpin_unbind(uint16_t tx_port, uint16_t rx_port);
2670 
2671 /**
2672  * @warning
2673  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change without prior notice.
2674  *
2675  *  Get the number of aggregated ports of the DPDK port (specified with port_id).
2676  *  It is used when multiple ports are aggregated into a single one.
2677  *
2678  *  For the regular physical port doesn't have aggregated ports,
2679  *  the number of aggregated ports is reported as 0.
2680  *
2681  * @param port_id
2682  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
2683  * @return
2684  *   - (>=0) the number of aggregated port if success.
2685  */
2686 __rte_experimental
2687 int rte_eth_dev_count_aggr_ports(uint16_t port_id);
2688 
2689 /**
2690  * @warning
2691  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change without prior notice.
2692  *
2693  *  Map a Tx queue with an aggregated port of the DPDK port (specified with port_id).
2694  *  When multiple ports are aggregated into a single one,
2695  *  it allows to choose which port to use for Tx via a queue.
2696  *
2697  *  The application should use rte_eth_dev_map_aggr_tx_affinity()
2698  *  after rte_eth_dev_configure(), rte_eth_tx_queue_setup(), and
2699  *  before rte_eth_dev_start().
2700  *
2701  * @param port_id
2702  *   The identifier of the port used in rte_eth_tx_burst().
2703  * @param tx_queue_id
2704  *   The index of the transmit queue used in rte_eth_tx_burst().
2705  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_tx_queue - 1] previously supplied
2706  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure().
2707  * @param affinity
2708  *   The number of the aggregated port.
2709  *   Value 0 means no affinity and traffic could be routed to any aggregated port.
2710  *   The first aggregated port is number 1 and so on.
2711  *   The maximum number is given by rte_eth_dev_count_aggr_ports().
2712  *
2713  * @return
2714  *   Zero if successful. Non-zero otherwise.
2715  */
2716 __rte_experimental
2717 int rte_eth_dev_map_aggr_tx_affinity(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t tx_queue_id,
2718 				     uint8_t affinity);
2719 
2720 /**
2721  * Return the NUMA socket to which an Ethernet device is connected
2722  *
2723  * @param port_id
2724  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device
2725  * @return
2726  *   - The NUMA socket ID which the Ethernet device is connected to.
2727  *   - -1 (which translates to SOCKET_ID_ANY) if the socket could not be
2728  *     determined. rte_errno is then set to:
2729  *     - EINVAL is the port_id is invalid,
2730  *     - 0 is the socket could not be determined,
2731  */
2732 int rte_eth_dev_socket_id(uint16_t port_id);
2733 
2734 /**
2735  * Check if port_id of device is attached
2736  *
2737  * @param port_id
2738  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device
2739  * @return
2740  *   - 0 if port is out of range or not attached
2741  *   - 1 if device is attached
2742  */
2743 int rte_eth_dev_is_valid_port(uint16_t port_id);
2744 
2745 /**
2746  * @warning
2747  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice.
2748  *
2749  * Check if Rx queue is valid.
2750  * If the queue has been setup, it is considered valid.
2751  *
2752  * @param port_id
2753  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
2754  * @param queue_id
2755  *   The index of the receive queue.
2756  * @return
2757  *   - -ENODEV: if port_id is invalid.
2758  *   - -EINVAL: if queue_id is out of range or queue has not been setup.
2759  *   - 0 if Rx queue is valid.
2760  */
2761 __rte_experimental
2762 int rte_eth_rx_queue_is_valid(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id);
2763 
2764 /**
2765  * @warning
2766  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice.
2767  *
2768  * Check if Tx queue is valid.
2769  * If the queue has been setup, it is considered valid.
2770  *
2771  * @param port_id
2772  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
2773  * @param queue_id
2774  *   The index of the transmit queue.
2775  * @return
2776  *   - -ENODEV: if port_id is invalid.
2777  *   - -EINVAL: if queue_id is out of range or queue has not been setup.
2778  *   - 0 if Tx queue is valid.
2779  */
2780 __rte_experimental
2781 int rte_eth_tx_queue_is_valid(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id);
2782 
2783 /**
2784  * Start specified Rx queue of a port. It is used when rx_deferred_start
2785  * flag of the specified queue is true.
2786  *
2787  * @param port_id
2788  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device
2789  * @param rx_queue_id
2790  *   The index of the Rx queue to update the ring.
2791  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_rx_queue - 1] previously supplied
2792  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure().
2793  * @return
2794  *   - 0: Success, the receive queue is started.
2795  *   - -ENODEV: if *port_id* is invalid.
2796  *   - -EINVAL: The queue_id out of range or belong to hairpin.
2797  *   - -EIO: if device is removed.
2798  *   - -ENOTSUP: The function not supported in PMD.
2799  */
2800 int rte_eth_dev_rx_queue_start(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t rx_queue_id);
2801 
2802 /**
2803  * Stop specified Rx queue of a port
2804  *
2805  * @param port_id
2806  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device
2807  * @param rx_queue_id
2808  *   The index of the Rx queue to update the ring.
2809  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_rx_queue - 1] previously supplied
2810  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure().
2811  * @return
2812  *   - 0: Success, the receive queue is stopped.
2813  *   - -ENODEV: if *port_id* is invalid.
2814  *   - -EINVAL: The queue_id out of range or belong to hairpin.
2815  *   - -EIO: if device is removed.
2816  *   - -ENOTSUP: The function not supported in PMD.
2817  */
2818 int rte_eth_dev_rx_queue_stop(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t rx_queue_id);
2819 
2820 /**
2821  * Start Tx for specified queue of a port. It is used when tx_deferred_start
2822  * flag of the specified queue is true.
2823  *
2824  * @param port_id
2825  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device
2826  * @param tx_queue_id
2827  *   The index of the Tx queue to update the ring.
2828  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_tx_queue - 1] previously supplied
2829  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure().
2830  * @return
2831  *   - 0: Success, the transmit queue is started.
2832  *   - -ENODEV: if *port_id* is invalid.
2833  *   - -EINVAL: The queue_id out of range or belong to hairpin.
2834  *   - -EIO: if device is removed.
2835  *   - -ENOTSUP: The function not supported in PMD.
2836  */
2837 int rte_eth_dev_tx_queue_start(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t tx_queue_id);
2838 
2839 /**
2840  * Stop specified Tx queue of a port
2841  *
2842  * @param port_id
2843  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device
2844  * @param tx_queue_id
2845  *   The index of the Tx queue to update the ring.
2846  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_tx_queue - 1] previously supplied
2847  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure().
2848  * @return
2849  *   - 0: Success, the transmit queue is stopped.
2850  *   - -ENODEV: if *port_id* is invalid.
2851  *   - -EINVAL: The queue_id out of range or belong to hairpin.
2852  *   - -EIO: if device is removed.
2853  *   - -ENOTSUP: The function not supported in PMD.
2854  */
2855 int rte_eth_dev_tx_queue_stop(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t tx_queue_id);
2856 
2857 /**
2858  * Start an Ethernet device.
2859  *
2860  * The device start step is the last one and consists of setting the configured
2861  * offload features and in starting the transmit and the receive units of the
2862  * device.
2863  *
2864  * Device RTE_ETH_DEV_NOLIVE_MAC_ADDR flag causes MAC address to be set before
2865  * PMD port start callback function is invoked.
2866  *
2867  * All device queues (except form deferred start queues) status should be
2868  * `RTE_ETH_QUEUE_STATE_STARTED` after start.
2869  *
2870  * On success, all basic functions exported by the Ethernet API (link status,
2871  * receive/transmit, and so on) can be invoked.
2872  *
2873  * @param port_id
2874  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
2875  * @return
2876  *   - 0: Success, Ethernet device started.
2877  *   - -EAGAIN: If start operation must be retried.
2878  *   - <0: Error code of the driver device start function.
2879  */
2880 int rte_eth_dev_start(uint16_t port_id);
2881 
2882 /**
2883  * Stop an Ethernet device. The device can be restarted with a call to
2884  * rte_eth_dev_start()
2885  *
2886  * All device queues status should be `RTE_ETH_QUEUE_STATE_STOPPED` after stop.
2887  *
2888  * @param port_id
2889  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
2890  * @return
2891  *   - 0: Success, Ethernet device stopped.
2892  *   - -EBUSY: If stopping the port is not allowed in current state.
2893  *   - <0: Error code of the driver device stop function.
2894  */
2895 int rte_eth_dev_stop(uint16_t port_id);
2896 
2897 /**
2898  * Link up an Ethernet device.
2899  *
2900  * Set device link up will re-enable the device Rx/Tx
2901  * functionality after it is previously set device linked down.
2902  *
2903  * @param port_id
2904  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
2905  * @return
2906  *   - 0: Success, Ethernet device linked up.
2907  *   - <0: Error code of the driver device link up function.
2908  */
2909 int rte_eth_dev_set_link_up(uint16_t port_id);
2910 
2911 /**
2912  * Link down an Ethernet device.
2913  * The device Rx/Tx functionality will be disabled if success,
2914  * and it can be re-enabled with a call to
2915  * rte_eth_dev_set_link_up()
2916  *
2917  * @param port_id
2918  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
2919  */
2920 int rte_eth_dev_set_link_down(uint16_t port_id);
2921 
2922 /**
2923  * Close a stopped Ethernet device. The device cannot be restarted!
2924  * The function frees all port resources.
2925  *
2926  * @param port_id
2927  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
2928  * @return
2929  *   - Zero if the port is closed successfully.
2930  *   - Negative if something went wrong.
2931  */
2932 int rte_eth_dev_close(uint16_t port_id);
2933 
2934 /**
2935  * Reset a Ethernet device and keep its port ID.
2936  *
2937  * When a port has to be reset passively, the DPDK application can invoke
2938  * this function. For example when a PF is reset, all its VFs should also
2939  * be reset. Normally a DPDK application can invoke this function when
2940  * RTE_ETH_EVENT_INTR_RESET event is detected, but can also use it to start
2941  * a port reset in other circumstances.
2942  *
2943  * When this function is called, it first stops the port and then calls the
2944  * PMD specific dev_uninit( ) and dev_init( ) to return the port to initial
2945  * state, in which no Tx and Rx queues are setup, as if the port has been
2946  * reset and not started. The port keeps the port ID it had before the
2947  * function call.
2948  *
2949  * After calling rte_eth_dev_reset( ), the application should use
2950  * rte_eth_dev_configure( ), rte_eth_rx_queue_setup( ),
2951  * rte_eth_tx_queue_setup( ), and rte_eth_dev_start( )
2952  * to reconfigure the device as appropriate.
2953  *
2954  * Note: To avoid unexpected behavior, the application should stop calling
2955  * Tx and Rx functions before calling rte_eth_dev_reset( ). For thread
2956  * safety, all these controlling functions should be called from the same
2957  * thread.
2958  *
2959  * @param port_id
2960  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
2961  *
2962  * @return
2963  *   - (0) if successful.
2964  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* is invalid.
2965  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support this function.
2966  *   - (-EPERM) if not ran from the primary process.
2967  *   - (-EIO) if re-initialisation failed or device is removed.
2968  *   - (-ENOMEM) if the reset failed due to OOM.
2969  *   - (-EAGAIN) if the reset temporarily failed and should be retried later.
2970  */
2971 int rte_eth_dev_reset(uint16_t port_id);
2972 
2973 /**
2974  * Enable receipt in promiscuous mode for an Ethernet device.
2975  *
2976  * @param port_id
2977  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
2978  * @return
2979  *   - (0) if successful.
2980  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if support for promiscuous_enable() does not exist
2981  *     for the device.
2982  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
2983  */
2984 int rte_eth_promiscuous_enable(uint16_t port_id);
2985 
2986 /**
2987  * Disable receipt in promiscuous mode for an Ethernet device.
2988  *
2989  * @param port_id
2990  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
2991  * @return
2992  *   - (0) if successful.
2993  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if support for promiscuous_disable() does not exist
2994  *     for the device.
2995  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
2996  */
2997 int rte_eth_promiscuous_disable(uint16_t port_id);
2998 
2999 /**
3000  * Return the value of promiscuous mode for an Ethernet device.
3001  *
3002  * @param port_id
3003  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3004  * @return
3005  *   - (1) if promiscuous is enabled
3006  *   - (0) if promiscuous is disabled.
3007  *   - (-1) on error
3008  */
3009 int rte_eth_promiscuous_get(uint16_t port_id);
3010 
3011 /**
3012  * Enable the receipt of any multicast frame by an Ethernet device.
3013  *
3014  * @param port_id
3015  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3016  * @return
3017  *   - (0) if successful.
3018  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if support for allmulticast_enable() does not exist
3019  *     for the device.
3020  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
3021  */
3022 int rte_eth_allmulticast_enable(uint16_t port_id);
3023 
3024 /**
3025  * Disable the receipt of all multicast frames by an Ethernet device.
3026  *
3027  * @param port_id
3028  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3029  * @return
3030  *   - (0) if successful.
3031  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if support for allmulticast_disable() does not exist
3032  *     for the device.
3033  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
3034  */
3035 int rte_eth_allmulticast_disable(uint16_t port_id);
3036 
3037 /**
3038  * Return the value of allmulticast mode for an Ethernet device.
3039  *
3040  * @param port_id
3041  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3042  * @return
3043  *   - (1) if allmulticast is enabled
3044  *   - (0) if allmulticast is disabled.
3045  *   - (-1) on error
3046  */
3047 int rte_eth_allmulticast_get(uint16_t port_id);
3048 
3049 /**
3050  * Retrieve the link status (up/down), the duplex mode (half/full),
3051  * the negotiation (auto/fixed), and if available, the speed (Mbps).
3052  *
3053  * It might need to wait up to 9 seconds.
3054  * @see rte_eth_link_get_nowait.
3055  *
3056  * @param port_id
3057  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3058  * @param link
3059  *   Link information written back.
3060  * @return
3061  *   - (0) if successful.
3062  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if the function is not supported in PMD.
3063  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
3064  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
3065  */
3066 int rte_eth_link_get(uint16_t port_id, struct rte_eth_link *link);
3067 
3068 /**
3069  * Retrieve the link status (up/down), the duplex mode (half/full),
3070  * the negotiation (auto/fixed), and if available, the speed (Mbps).
3071  *
3072  * @param port_id
3073  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3074  * @param link
3075  *   Link information written back.
3076  * @return
3077  *   - (0) if successful.
3078  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if the function is not supported in PMD.
3079  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
3080  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
3081  */
3082 int rte_eth_link_get_nowait(uint16_t port_id, struct rte_eth_link *link);
3083 
3084 /**
3085  * @warning
3086  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change without prior notice.
3087  *
3088  * The function converts a link_speed to a string. It handles all special
3089  * values like unknown or none speed.
3090  *
3091  * @param link_speed
3092  *   link_speed of rte_eth_link struct
3093  * @return
3094  *   Link speed in textual format. It's pointer to immutable memory.
3095  *   No free is required.
3096  */
3097 __rte_experimental
3098 const char *rte_eth_link_speed_to_str(uint32_t link_speed);
3099 
3100 /**
3101  * @warning
3102  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change without prior notice.
3103  *
3104  * The function converts a rte_eth_link struct representing a link status to
3105  * a string.
3106  *
3107  * @param str
3108  *   A pointer to a string to be filled with textual representation of
3109  *   device status. At least RTE_ETH_LINK_MAX_STR_LEN bytes should be allocated to
3110  *   store default link status text.
3111  * @param len
3112  *   Length of available memory at 'str' string.
3113  * @param eth_link
3114  *   Link status returned by rte_eth_link_get function
3115  * @return
3116  *   Number of bytes written to str array or -EINVAL if bad parameter.
3117  */
3118 __rte_experimental
3119 int rte_eth_link_to_str(char *str, size_t len,
3120 			const struct rte_eth_link *eth_link);
3121 
3122 /**
3123  * @warning
3124  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
3125  *
3126  * Get Active lanes.
3127  *
3128  * @param port_id
3129  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3130  * @param lanes
3131  *   Driver updates lanes with the number of active lanes.
3132  *   On a supported NIC on link up, lanes will be a non-zero value irrespective whether the
3133  *   link is Autonegotiated or Fixed speed. No information is displayed for error.
3134  *
3135  * @return
3136  *   - (0) if successful.
3137  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if underlying hardware OR driver doesn't support.
3138  *     that operation.
3139  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
3140  *   - (-ENODEV)  if *port_id* invalid.
3141  */
3142 __rte_experimental
3143 int rte_eth_speed_lanes_get(uint16_t port_id, uint32_t *lanes);
3144 
3145 /**
3146  * @warning
3147  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
3148  *
3149  * Set speed lanes supported by the NIC.
3150  *
3151  * @param port_id
3152  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3153  * @param speed_lanes
3154  *   A non-zero number of speed lanes, that will be applied to the ethernet PHY
3155  *   along with the fixed speed configuration. Driver returns error if the user
3156  *   lanes is not in speeds capability list.
3157  *
3158  * @return
3159  *   - (0) if successful.
3160  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if underlying hardware OR driver doesn't support.
3161  *     that operation.
3162  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
3163  *   - (-ENODEV)  if *port_id* invalid.
3164  *   - (-EINVAL)  if *lanes* count not in speeds capability list.
3165  */
3166 __rte_experimental
3167 int rte_eth_speed_lanes_set(uint16_t port_id, uint32_t speed_lanes);
3168 
3169 /**
3170  * @warning
3171  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
3172  *
3173  * Get speed lanes supported by the NIC.
3174  *
3175  * @param port_id
3176  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3177  * @param speed_lanes_capa
3178  *   An array of supported speed and its supported lanes.
3179  * @param num
3180  *   Size of the speed_lanes_capa array. The size is equal to the supported speeds list size.
3181  *   Value of num is derived by calling this api with speed_lanes_capa=NULL and num=0
3182  *
3183  * @return
3184  *   - (0) if successful.
3185  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if underlying hardware OR driver doesn't support.
3186  *     that operation.
3187  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
3188  *   - (-ENODEV)  if *port_id* invalid.
3189  *   - (-EINVAL)  if *speed_lanes* invalid
3190  */
3191 __rte_experimental
3192 int rte_eth_speed_lanes_get_capability(uint16_t port_id,
3193 				       struct rte_eth_speed_lanes_capa *speed_lanes_capa,
3194 				       unsigned int num);
3195 
3196 /**
3197  * Retrieve the general I/O statistics of an Ethernet device.
3198  *
3199  * @param port_id
3200  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3201  * @param stats
3202  *   A pointer to a structure of type *rte_eth_stats* to be filled with
3203  *   the values of device counters for the following set of statistics:
3204  *   - *ipackets* with the total of successfully received packets.
3205  *   - *opackets* with the total of successfully transmitted packets.
3206  *   - *ibytes*   with the total of successfully received bytes.
3207  *   - *obytes*   with the total of successfully transmitted bytes.
3208  *   - *ierrors*  with the total of erroneous received packets.
3209  *   - *oerrors*  with the total of failed transmitted packets.
3210  * @return
3211  *   Zero if successful. Non-zero otherwise.
3212  */
3213 int rte_eth_stats_get(uint16_t port_id, struct rte_eth_stats *stats);
3214 
3215 /**
3216  * Reset the general I/O statistics of an Ethernet device.
3217  *
3218  * @param port_id
3219  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3220  * @return
3221  *   - (0) if device notified to reset stats.
3222  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support.
3223  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
3224  *   - (<0): Error code of the driver stats reset function.
3225  */
3226 int rte_eth_stats_reset(uint16_t port_id);
3227 
3228 /**
3229  * Retrieve names of extended statistics of an Ethernet device.
3230  *
3231  * There is an assumption that 'xstat_names' and 'xstats' arrays are matched
3232  * by array index:
3233  *  xstats_names[i].name => xstats[i].value
3234  *
3235  * And the array index is same with id field of 'struct rte_eth_xstat':
3236  *  xstats[i].id == i
3237  *
3238  * This assumption makes key-value pair matching less flexible but simpler.
3239  *
3240  * @param port_id
3241  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3242  * @param xstats_names
3243  *   An rte_eth_xstat_name array of at least *size* elements to
3244  *   be filled. If set to NULL, the function returns the required number
3245  *   of elements.
3246  * @param size
3247  *   The size of the xstats_names array (number of elements).
3248  * @return
3249  *   - A positive value lower or equal to size: success. The return value
3250  *     is the number of entries filled in the stats table.
3251  *   - A positive value higher than size: error, the given statistics table
3252  *     is too small. The return value corresponds to the size that should
3253  *     be given to succeed. The entries in the table are not valid and
3254  *     shall not be used by the caller.
3255  *   - A negative value on error (invalid port ID).
3256  */
3257 int rte_eth_xstats_get_names(uint16_t port_id,
3258 		struct rte_eth_xstat_name *xstats_names,
3259 		unsigned int size);
3260 
3261 /**
3262  * Retrieve extended statistics of an Ethernet device.
3263  *
3264  * There is an assumption that 'xstat_names' and 'xstats' arrays are matched
3265  * by array index:
3266  *  xstats_names[i].name => xstats[i].value
3267  *
3268  * And the array index is same with id field of 'struct rte_eth_xstat':
3269  *  xstats[i].id == i
3270  *
3271  * This assumption makes key-value pair matching less flexible but simpler.
3272  *
3273  * @param port_id
3274  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3275  * @param xstats
3276  *   A pointer to a table of structure of type *rte_eth_xstat*
3277  *   to be filled with device statistics ids and values.
3278  *   This parameter can be set to NULL if and only if n is 0.
3279  * @param n
3280  *   The size of the xstats array (number of elements).
3281  *   If lower than the required number of elements, the function returns
3282  *   the required number of elements.
3283  *   If equal to zero, the xstats must be NULL, the function returns the
3284  *   required number of elements.
3285  * @return
3286  *   - A positive value lower or equal to n: success. The return value
3287  *     is the number of entries filled in the stats table.
3288  *   - A positive value higher than n: error, the given statistics table
3289  *     is too small. The return value corresponds to the size that should
3290  *     be given to succeed. The entries in the table are not valid and
3291  *     shall not be used by the caller.
3292  *   - A negative value on error (invalid port ID).
3293  */
3294 int rte_eth_xstats_get(uint16_t port_id, struct rte_eth_xstat *xstats,
3295 		unsigned int n);
3296 
3297 /**
3298  * Retrieve names of extended statistics of an Ethernet device.
3299  *
3300  * @param port_id
3301  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3302  * @param xstats_names
3303  *   Array to be filled in with names of requested device statistics.
3304  *   Must not be NULL if @p ids are specified (not NULL).
3305  * @param size
3306  *   Number of elements in @p xstats_names array (if not NULL) and in
3307  *   @p ids array (if not NULL). Must be 0 if both array pointers are NULL.
3308  * @param ids
3309  *   IDs array given by app to retrieve specific statistics. May be NULL to
3310  *   retrieve names of all available statistics or, if @p xstats_names is
3311  *   NULL as well, just the number of available statistics.
3312  * @return
3313  *   - A positive value lower or equal to size: success. The return value
3314  *     is the number of entries filled in the stats table.
3315  *   - A positive value higher than size: success. The given statistics table
3316  *     is too small. The return value corresponds to the size that should
3317  *     be given to succeed. The entries in the table are not valid and
3318  *     shall not be used by the caller.
3319  *   - A negative value on error.
3320  */
3321 int
3322 rte_eth_xstats_get_names_by_id(uint16_t port_id,
3323 	struct rte_eth_xstat_name *xstats_names, unsigned int size,
3324 	uint64_t *ids);
3325 
3326 /**
3327  * Retrieve extended statistics of an Ethernet device.
3328  *
3329  * @param port_id
3330  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3331  * @param ids
3332  *   IDs array given by app to retrieve specific statistics. May be NULL to
3333  *   retrieve all available statistics or, if @p values is NULL as well,
3334  *   just the number of available statistics.
3335  * @param values
3336  *   Array to be filled in with requested device statistics.
3337  *   Must not be NULL if ids are specified (not NULL).
3338  * @param size
3339  *   Number of elements in @p values array (if not NULL) and in @p ids
3340  *   array (if not NULL). Must be 0 if both array pointers are NULL.
3341  * @return
3342  *   - A positive value lower or equal to size: success. The return value
3343  *     is the number of entries filled in the stats table.
3344  *   - A positive value higher than size: success: The given statistics table
3345  *     is too small. The return value corresponds to the size that should
3346  *     be given to succeed. The entries in the table are not valid and
3347  *     shall not be used by the caller.
3348  *   - A negative value on error.
3349  */
3350 int rte_eth_xstats_get_by_id(uint16_t port_id, const uint64_t *ids,
3351 			     uint64_t *values, unsigned int size);
3352 
3353 /**
3354  * Gets the ID of a statistic from its name.
3355  *
3356  * This function searches for the statistics using string compares, and
3357  * as such should not be used on the fast-path. For fast-path retrieval of
3358  * specific statistics, store the ID as provided in *id* from this function,
3359  * and pass the ID to rte_eth_xstats_get()
3360  *
3361  * @param port_id The port to look up statistics from
3362  * @param xstat_name The name of the statistic to return
3363  * @param[out] id A pointer to an app-supplied uint64_t which should be
3364  *                set to the ID of the stat if the stat exists.
3365  * @return
3366  *    0 on success
3367  *    -ENODEV for invalid port_id,
3368  *    -EIO if device is removed,
3369  *    -EINVAL if the xstat_name doesn't exist in port_id
3370  *    -ENOMEM if bad parameter.
3371  */
3372 int rte_eth_xstats_get_id_by_name(uint16_t port_id, const char *xstat_name,
3373 		uint64_t *id);
3374 
3375 /**
3376  * Reset extended statistics of an Ethernet device.
3377  *
3378  * @param port_id
3379  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3380  * @return
3381  *   - (0) if device notified to reset extended stats.
3382  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if pmd doesn't support both
3383  *     extended stats and basic stats reset.
3384  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
3385  *   - (<0): Error code of the driver xstats reset function.
3386  */
3387 int rte_eth_xstats_reset(uint16_t port_id);
3388 
3389 /**
3390  *  Set a mapping for the specified transmit queue to the specified per-queue
3391  *  statistics counter.
3392  *
3393  * @param port_id
3394  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3395  * @param tx_queue_id
3396  *   The index of the transmit queue for which a queue stats mapping is required.
3397  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_tx_queue - 1] previously supplied
3398  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure().
3399  * @param stat_idx
3400  *   The per-queue packet statistics functionality number that the transmit
3401  *   queue is to be assigned.
3402  *   The value must be in the range [0, RTE_ETHDEV_QUEUE_STAT_CNTRS - 1].
3403  *   Max RTE_ETHDEV_QUEUE_STAT_CNTRS being 256.
3404  * @return
3405  *   Zero if successful. Non-zero otherwise.
3406  */
3407 int rte_eth_dev_set_tx_queue_stats_mapping(uint16_t port_id,
3408 		uint16_t tx_queue_id, uint8_t stat_idx);
3409 
3410 /**
3411  *  Set a mapping for the specified receive queue to the specified per-queue
3412  *  statistics counter.
3413  *
3414  * @param port_id
3415  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3416  * @param rx_queue_id
3417  *   The index of the receive queue for which a queue stats mapping is required.
3418  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_rx_queue - 1] previously supplied
3419  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure().
3420  * @param stat_idx
3421  *   The per-queue packet statistics functionality number that the receive
3422  *   queue is to be assigned.
3423  *   The value must be in the range [0, RTE_ETHDEV_QUEUE_STAT_CNTRS - 1].
3424  *   Max RTE_ETHDEV_QUEUE_STAT_CNTRS being 256.
3425  * @return
3426  *   Zero if successful. Non-zero otherwise.
3427  */
3428 int rte_eth_dev_set_rx_queue_stats_mapping(uint16_t port_id,
3429 					   uint16_t rx_queue_id,
3430 					   uint8_t stat_idx);
3431 
3432 /**
3433  * Retrieve the Ethernet address of an Ethernet device.
3434  *
3435  * @param port_id
3436  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3437  * @param mac_addr
3438  *   A pointer to a structure of type *ether_addr* to be filled with
3439  *   the Ethernet address of the Ethernet device.
3440  * @return
3441  *   - (0) if successful
3442  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
3443  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
3444  */
3445 int rte_eth_macaddr_get(uint16_t port_id, struct rte_ether_addr *mac_addr);
3446 
3447 /**
3448  * @warning
3449  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change without prior notice
3450  *
3451  * Retrieve the Ethernet addresses of an Ethernet device.
3452  *
3453  * @param port_id
3454  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3455  * @param ma
3456  *   A pointer to an array of structures of type *ether_addr* to be filled with
3457  *   the Ethernet addresses of the Ethernet device.
3458  * @param num
3459  *   Number of elements in the @p ma array.
3460  *   Note that  rte_eth_dev_info::max_mac_addrs can be used to retrieve
3461  *   max number of Ethernet addresses for given port.
3462  * @return
3463  *   - number of retrieved addresses if successful
3464  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
3465  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
3466  */
3467 __rte_experimental
3468 int rte_eth_macaddrs_get(uint16_t port_id, struct rte_ether_addr *ma,
3469 	unsigned int num);
3470 
3471 /**
3472  * Retrieve the contextual information of an Ethernet device.
3473  *
3474  * This function returns the Ethernet device information based
3475  * on the values stored internally in the device specific data.
3476  * For example: number of queues, descriptor limits, device
3477  * capabilities and offload flags.
3478  *
3479  * @param port_id
3480  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3481  * @param dev_info
3482  *   A pointer to a structure of type *rte_eth_dev_info* to be filled with
3483  *   the contextual information of the Ethernet device.
3484  * @return
3485  *   - (0) if successful.
3486  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if support for dev_infos_get() does not exist for the device.
3487  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
3488  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
3489  */
3490 int rte_eth_dev_info_get(uint16_t port_id, struct rte_eth_dev_info *dev_info);
3491 
3492 /**
3493  * @warning
3494  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change without prior notice.
3495  *
3496  * Retrieve the configuration of an Ethernet device.
3497  *
3498  * @param port_id
3499  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3500  * @param dev_conf
3501  *   Location for Ethernet device configuration to be filled in.
3502  * @return
3503  *   - (0) if successful.
3504  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
3505  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
3506  */
3507 __rte_experimental
3508 int rte_eth_dev_conf_get(uint16_t port_id, struct rte_eth_conf *dev_conf);
3509 
3510 /**
3511  * Retrieve the firmware version of a device.
3512  *
3513  * @param port_id
3514  *   The port identifier of the device.
3515  * @param fw_version
3516  *   A pointer to a string array storing the firmware version of a device,
3517  *   the string includes terminating null. This pointer is allocated by caller.
3518  * @param fw_size
3519  *   The size of the string array pointed by fw_version, which should be
3520  *   large enough to store firmware version of the device.
3521  * @return
3522  *   - (0) if successful.
3523  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if operation is not supported.
3524  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
3525  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
3526  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
3527  *   - (>0) if *fw_size* is not enough to store firmware version, return
3528  *          the size of the non truncated string.
3529  */
3530 int rte_eth_dev_fw_version_get(uint16_t port_id,
3531 			       char *fw_version, size_t fw_size);
3532 
3533 /**
3534  * Retrieve the supported packet types of an Ethernet device.
3535  *
3536  * When a packet type is announced as supported, it *must* be recognized by
3537  * the PMD. For instance, if RTE_PTYPE_L2_ETHER, RTE_PTYPE_L2_ETHER_VLAN
3538  * and RTE_PTYPE_L3_IPV4 are announced, the PMD must return the following
3539  * packet types for these packets:
3540  * - Ether/IPv4              -> RTE_PTYPE_L2_ETHER | RTE_PTYPE_L3_IPV4
3541  * - Ether/VLAN/IPv4         -> RTE_PTYPE_L2_ETHER_VLAN | RTE_PTYPE_L3_IPV4
3542  * - Ether/[anything else]   -> RTE_PTYPE_L2_ETHER
3543  * - Ether/VLAN/[anything else] -> RTE_PTYPE_L2_ETHER_VLAN
3544  *
3545  * When a packet is received by a PMD, the most precise type must be
3546  * returned among the ones supported. However a PMD is allowed to set
3547  * packet type that is not in the supported list, at the condition that it
3548  * is more precise. Therefore, a PMD announcing no supported packet types
3549  * can still set a matching packet type in a received packet.
3550  *
3551  * @note
3552  *   Better to invoke this API after the device is already started or Rx burst
3553  *   function is decided, to obtain correct supported ptypes.
3554  * @note
3555  *   if a given PMD does not report what ptypes it supports, then the supported
3556  *   ptype count is reported as 0.
3557  * @param port_id
3558  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3559  * @param ptype_mask
3560  *   A hint of what kind of packet type which the caller is interested in.
3561  * @param ptypes
3562  *   An array pointer to store adequate packet types, allocated by caller.
3563  * @param num
3564  *  Size of the array pointed by param ptypes.
3565  * @return
3566  *   - (>=0) Number of supported ptypes. If the number of types exceeds num,
3567  *           only num entries will be filled into the ptypes array, but the full
3568  *           count of supported ptypes will be returned.
3569  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
3570  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
3571  */
3572 int rte_eth_dev_get_supported_ptypes(uint16_t port_id, uint32_t ptype_mask,
3573 				     uint32_t *ptypes, int num);
3574 /**
3575  * Inform Ethernet device about reduced range of packet types to handle.
3576  *
3577  * Application can use this function to set only specific ptypes that it's
3578  * interested. This information can be used by the PMD to optimize Rx path.
3579  *
3580  * The function accepts an array `set_ptypes` allocated by the caller to
3581  * store the packet types set by the driver, the last element of the array
3582  * is set to RTE_PTYPE_UNKNOWN. The size of the `set_ptype` array should be
3583  * `rte_eth_dev_get_supported_ptypes() + 1` else it might only be filled
3584  * partially.
3585  *
3586  * @param port_id
3587  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3588  * @param ptype_mask
3589  *   The ptype family that application is interested in should be bitwise OR of
3590  *   RTE_PTYPE_*_MASK or 0.
3591  * @param set_ptypes
3592  *   An array pointer to store set packet types, allocated by caller. The
3593  *   function marks the end of array with RTE_PTYPE_UNKNOWN.
3594  * @param num
3595  *   Size of the array pointed by param ptypes.
3596  *   Should be rte_eth_dev_get_supported_ptypes() + 1 to accommodate the
3597  *   set ptypes.
3598  * @return
3599  *   - (0) if Success.
3600  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
3601  *   - (-EINVAL) if *ptype_mask* is invalid (or) set_ptypes is NULL and
3602  *     num > 0.
3603  */
3604 int rte_eth_dev_set_ptypes(uint16_t port_id, uint32_t ptype_mask,
3605 			   uint32_t *set_ptypes, unsigned int num);
3606 
3607 /**
3608  * Retrieve the MTU of an Ethernet device.
3609  *
3610  * @param port_id
3611  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3612  * @param mtu
3613  *   A pointer to a uint16_t where the retrieved MTU is to be stored.
3614  * @return
3615  *   - (0) if successful.
3616  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
3617  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
3618  */
3619 int rte_eth_dev_get_mtu(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t *mtu);
3620 
3621 /**
3622  * Change the MTU of an Ethernet device.
3623  *
3624  * @param port_id
3625  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3626  * @param mtu
3627  *   A uint16_t for the MTU to be applied.
3628  * @return
3629  *   - (0) if successful.
3630  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if operation is not supported.
3631  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
3632  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
3633  *   - (-EINVAL) if *mtu* invalid, validation of mtu can occur within
3634  *     rte_eth_dev_set_mtu if dev_infos_get is supported by the device or
3635  *     when the mtu is set using dev->dev_ops->mtu_set.
3636  *   - (-EBUSY) if operation is not allowed when the port is running
3637  */
3638 int rte_eth_dev_set_mtu(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t mtu);
3639 
3640 /**
3641  * Enable/Disable hardware filtering by an Ethernet device of received
3642  * VLAN packets tagged with a given VLAN Tag Identifier.
3643  *
3644  * @param port_id
3645  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3646  * @param vlan_id
3647  *   The VLAN Tag Identifier whose filtering must be enabled or disabled.
3648  * @param on
3649  *   If > 0, enable VLAN filtering of VLAN packets tagged with *vlan_id*.
3650  *   Otherwise, disable VLAN filtering of VLAN packets tagged with *vlan_id*.
3651  * @return
3652  *   - (0) if successful.
3653  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware-assisted VLAN filtering not configured.
3654  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
3655  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
3656  *   - (-ENOSYS) if VLAN filtering on *port_id* disabled.
3657  *   - (-EINVAL) if *vlan_id* > 4095.
3658  */
3659 int rte_eth_dev_vlan_filter(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t vlan_id, int on);
3660 
3661 /**
3662  * Enable/Disable hardware VLAN Strip by a Rx queue of an Ethernet device.
3663  *
3664  * @param port_id
3665  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3666  * @param rx_queue_id
3667  *   The index of the receive queue for which a queue stats mapping is required.
3668  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_rx_queue - 1] previously supplied
3669  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure().
3670  * @param on
3671  *   If 1, Enable VLAN Stripping of the receive queue of the Ethernet port.
3672  *   If 0, Disable VLAN Stripping of the receive queue of the Ethernet port.
3673  * @return
3674  *   - (0) if successful.
3675  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware-assisted VLAN stripping not configured.
3676  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
3677  *   - (-EINVAL) if *rx_queue_id* invalid.
3678  */
3679 int rte_eth_dev_set_vlan_strip_on_queue(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t rx_queue_id,
3680 		int on);
3681 
3682 /**
3683  * Set the Outer VLAN Ether Type by an Ethernet device, it can be inserted to
3684  * the VLAN header.
3685  *
3686  * @param port_id
3687  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3688  * @param vlan_type
3689  *   The VLAN type.
3690  * @param tag_type
3691  *   The Tag Protocol ID
3692  * @return
3693  *   - (0) if successful.
3694  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware-assisted VLAN TPID setup is not supported.
3695  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
3696  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
3697  */
3698 int rte_eth_dev_set_vlan_ether_type(uint16_t port_id,
3699 				    enum rte_vlan_type vlan_type,
3700 				    uint16_t tag_type);
3701 
3702 /**
3703  * Set VLAN offload configuration on an Ethernet device.
3704  *
3705  * @param port_id
3706  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3707  * @param offload_mask
3708  *   The VLAN Offload bit mask can be mixed use with "OR"
3709  *       RTE_ETH_VLAN_STRIP_OFFLOAD
3710  *       RTE_ETH_VLAN_FILTER_OFFLOAD
3711  *       RTE_ETH_VLAN_EXTEND_OFFLOAD
3712  *       RTE_ETH_QINQ_STRIP_OFFLOAD
3713  * @return
3714  *   - (0) if successful.
3715  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware-assisted VLAN filtering not configured.
3716  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
3717  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
3718  */
3719 int rte_eth_dev_set_vlan_offload(uint16_t port_id, int offload_mask);
3720 
3721 /**
3722  * Read VLAN Offload configuration from an Ethernet device
3723  *
3724  * @param port_id
3725  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3726  * @return
3727  *   - (>0) if successful. Bit mask to indicate
3728  *       RTE_ETH_VLAN_STRIP_OFFLOAD
3729  *       RTE_ETH_VLAN_FILTER_OFFLOAD
3730  *       RTE_ETH_VLAN_EXTEND_OFFLOAD
3731  *       RTE_ETH_QINQ_STRIP_OFFLOAD
3732  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
3733  */
3734 int rte_eth_dev_get_vlan_offload(uint16_t port_id);
3735 
3736 /**
3737  * Set port based Tx VLAN insertion on or off.
3738  *
3739  * @param port_id
3740  *  The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3741  * @param pvid
3742  *  Port based Tx VLAN identifier together with user priority.
3743  * @param on
3744  *  Turn on or off the port based Tx VLAN insertion.
3745  *
3746  * @return
3747  *   - (0) if successful.
3748  *   - negative if failed.
3749  */
3750 int rte_eth_dev_set_vlan_pvid(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t pvid, int on);
3751 
3752 /**
3753  * @warning
3754  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change without prior notice.
3755  *
3756  * Set Rx queue available descriptors threshold.
3757  *
3758  * @param port_id
3759  *  The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3760  * @param queue_id
3761  *  The index of the receive queue.
3762  * @param avail_thresh
3763  *  The available descriptors threshold is percentage of Rx queue size
3764  *  which describes the availability of Rx queue for hardware.
3765  *  If the Rx queue availability is below it,
3766  *  the event RTE_ETH_EVENT_RX_AVAIL_THRESH is triggered.
3767  *  [1-99] to set a new available descriptors threshold.
3768  *  0 to disable threshold monitoring.
3769  *
3770  * @return
3771  *   - 0 if successful.
3772  *   - (-ENODEV) if @p port_id is invalid.
3773  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
3774  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if available Rx descriptors threshold is not supported.
3775  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
3776  */
3777 __rte_experimental
3778 int rte_eth_rx_avail_thresh_set(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id,
3779 			       uint8_t avail_thresh);
3780 
3781 /**
3782  * @warning
3783  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change without prior notice.
3784  *
3785  * Find Rx queue with RTE_ETH_EVENT_RX_AVAIL_THRESH event pending.
3786  *
3787  * @param port_id
3788  *  The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3789  * @param[inout] queue_id
3790  *  On input starting Rx queue index to search from.
3791  *  If the queue_id is bigger than maximum queue ID of the port,
3792  *  search is started from 0. So that application can keep calling
3793  *  this function to handle all pending events with a simple increment
3794  *  of queue_id on the next call.
3795  *  On output if return value is 1, Rx queue index with the event pending.
3796  * @param[out] avail_thresh
3797  *  Location for available descriptors threshold of the found Rx queue.
3798  *
3799  * @return
3800  *   - 1 if an Rx queue with pending event is found.
3801  *   - 0 if no Rx queue with pending event is found.
3802  *   - (-ENODEV) if @p port_id is invalid.
3803  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter (e.g. @p queue_id is NULL).
3804  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if operation is not supported.
3805  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
3806  */
3807 __rte_experimental
3808 int rte_eth_rx_avail_thresh_query(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t *queue_id,
3809 				 uint8_t *avail_thresh);
3810 
3811 typedef void (*buffer_tx_error_fn)(struct rte_mbuf **unsent, uint16_t count,
3812 		void *userdata);
3813 
3814 /**
3815  * Structure used to buffer packets for future Tx
3816  * Used by APIs rte_eth_tx_buffer and rte_eth_tx_buffer_flush
3817  */
3818 struct rte_eth_dev_tx_buffer {
3819 	buffer_tx_error_fn error_callback;
3820 	void *error_userdata;
3821 	uint16_t size;           /**< Size of buffer for buffered Tx */
3822 	uint16_t length;         /**< Number of packets in the array */
3823 	/** Pending packets to be sent on explicit flush or when full */
3824 	struct rte_mbuf *pkts[];
3825 };
3826 
3827 /**
3828  * Calculate the size of the Tx buffer.
3829  *
3830  * @param sz
3831  *   Number of stored packets.
3832  */
3833 #define RTE_ETH_TX_BUFFER_SIZE(sz) \
3834 	(sizeof(struct rte_eth_dev_tx_buffer) + (sz) * sizeof(struct rte_mbuf *))
3835 
3836 /**
3837  * Initialize default values for buffered transmitting
3838  *
3839  * @param buffer
3840  *   Tx buffer to be initialized.
3841  * @param size
3842  *   Buffer size
3843  * @return
3844  *   0 if no error
3845  */
3846 int
3847 rte_eth_tx_buffer_init(struct rte_eth_dev_tx_buffer *buffer, uint16_t size);
3848 
3849 /**
3850  * Configure a callback for buffered packets which cannot be sent
3851  *
3852  * Register a specific callback to be called when an attempt is made to send
3853  * all packets buffered on an Ethernet port, but not all packets can
3854  * successfully be sent. The callback registered here will be called only
3855  * from calls to rte_eth_tx_buffer() and rte_eth_tx_buffer_flush() APIs.
3856  * The default callback configured for each queue by default just frees the
3857  * packets back to the calling mempool. If additional behaviour is required,
3858  * for example, to count dropped packets, or to retry transmission of packets
3859  * which cannot be sent, this function should be used to register a suitable
3860  * callback function to implement the desired behaviour.
3861  * The example callback "rte_eth_tx_buffer_count_callback()" is also
3862  * provided as reference.
3863  *
3864  * @param buffer
3865  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3866  * @param callback
3867  *   The function to be used as the callback.
3868  * @param userdata
3869  *   Arbitrary parameter to be passed to the callback function
3870  * @return
3871  *   0 on success, or -EINVAL if bad parameter
3872  */
3873 int
3874 rte_eth_tx_buffer_set_err_callback(struct rte_eth_dev_tx_buffer *buffer,
3875 		buffer_tx_error_fn callback, void *userdata);
3876 
3877 /**
3878  * Callback function for silently dropping unsent buffered packets.
3879  *
3880  * This function can be passed to rte_eth_tx_buffer_set_err_callback() to
3881  * adjust the default behavior when buffered packets cannot be sent. This
3882  * function drops any unsent packets silently and is used by Tx buffered
3883  * operations as default behavior.
3884  *
3885  * NOTE: this function should not be called directly, instead it should be used
3886  *       as a callback for packet buffering.
3887  *
3888  * NOTE: when configuring this function as a callback with
3889  *       rte_eth_tx_buffer_set_err_callback(), the final, userdata parameter
3890  *       should point to an uint64_t value.
3891  *
3892  * @param pkts
3893  *   The previously buffered packets which could not be sent
3894  * @param unsent
3895  *   The number of unsent packets in the pkts array
3896  * @param userdata
3897  *   Not used
3898  */
3899 void
3900 rte_eth_tx_buffer_drop_callback(struct rte_mbuf **pkts, uint16_t unsent,
3901 		void *userdata);
3902 
3903 /**
3904  * Callback function for tracking unsent buffered packets.
3905  *
3906  * This function can be passed to rte_eth_tx_buffer_set_err_callback() to
3907  * adjust the default behavior when buffered packets cannot be sent. This
3908  * function drops any unsent packets, but also updates a user-supplied counter
3909  * to track the overall number of packets dropped. The counter should be an
3910  * uint64_t variable.
3911  *
3912  * NOTE: this function should not be called directly, instead it should be used
3913  *       as a callback for packet buffering.
3914  *
3915  * NOTE: when configuring this function as a callback with
3916  *       rte_eth_tx_buffer_set_err_callback(), the final, userdata parameter
3917  *       should point to an uint64_t value.
3918  *
3919  * @param pkts
3920  *   The previously buffered packets which could not be sent
3921  * @param unsent
3922  *   The number of unsent packets in the pkts array
3923  * @param userdata
3924  *   Pointer to an uint64_t value, which will be incremented by unsent
3925  */
3926 void
3927 rte_eth_tx_buffer_count_callback(struct rte_mbuf **pkts, uint16_t unsent,
3928 		void *userdata);
3929 
3930 /**
3931  * Request the driver to free mbufs currently cached by the driver. The
3932  * driver will only free the mbuf if it is no longer in use. It is the
3933  * application's responsibility to ensure rte_eth_tx_buffer_flush(..) is
3934  * called if needed.
3935  *
3936  * @param port_id
3937  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
3938  * @param queue_id
3939  *   The index of the transmit queue through which output packets must be
3940  *   sent.
3941  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_tx_queue - 1] previously supplied
3942  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure().
3943  * @param free_cnt
3944  *   Maximum number of packets to free. Use 0 to indicate all possible packets
3945  *   should be freed. Note that a packet may be using multiple mbufs.
3946  * @return
3947  *   Failure: < 0
3948  *     -ENODEV: Invalid interface
3949  *     -EIO: device is removed
3950  *     -ENOTSUP: Driver does not support function
3951  *   Success: >= 0
3952  *     0-n: Number of packets freed. More packets may still remain in ring that
3953  *     are in use.
3954  */
3955 int
3956 rte_eth_tx_done_cleanup(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id, uint32_t free_cnt);
3957 
3958 /**
3959  * Subtypes for MACsec offload event (@ref RTE_ETH_EVENT_MACSEC)
3960  * raised by Ethernet device.
3961  */
3962 enum rte_eth_event_macsec_subtype {
3963 	/** Notifies unknown MACsec subevent. */
3964 	RTE_ETH_SUBEVENT_MACSEC_UNKNOWN,
3965 	/**
3966 	 * Subevent of RTE_ETH_EVENT_MACSEC_SECTAG_VAL_ERR sectag validation events
3967 	 *	Validation check: SecTag.TCI.V = 1
3968 	 */
3969 	RTE_ETH_SUBEVENT_MACSEC_RX_SECTAG_V_EQ1,
3970 	/**
3971 	 * Subevent of RTE_ETH_EVENT_MACSEC_SECTAG_VAL_ERR sectag validation events
3972 	 *	Validation check: SecTag.TCI.E = 0 && SecTag.TCI.C = 1
3973 	 */
3974 	RTE_ETH_SUBEVENT_MACSEC_RX_SECTAG_E_EQ0_C_EQ1,
3975 	/**
3976 	 * Subevent of RTE_ETH_EVENT_MACSEC_SECTAG_VAL_ERR sectag validation events
3977 	 *	Validation check: SecTag.SL >= 'd48
3978 	 */
3979 	RTE_ETH_SUBEVENT_MACSEC_RX_SECTAG_SL_GTE48,
3980 	/**
3981 	 * Subevent of RTE_ETH_EVENT_MACSEC_SECTAG_VAL_ERR sectag validation events
3982 	 *	Validation check: SecTag.TCI.ES = 1 && SecTag.TCI.SC = 1
3983 	 */
3984 	RTE_ETH_SUBEVENT_MACSEC_RX_SECTAG_ES_EQ1_SC_EQ1,
3985 	/**
3986 	 * Subevent of RTE_ETH_EVENT_MACSEC_SECTAG_VAL_ERR sectag validation events
3987 	 *	Validation check: SecTag.TCI.SC = 1 && SecTag.TCI.SCB = 1
3988 	 */
3989 	RTE_ETH_SUBEVENT_MACSEC_RX_SECTAG_SC_EQ1_SCB_EQ1,
3990 };
3991 
3992 /**
3993  * Event types for MACsec offload event (@ref RTE_ETH_EVENT_MACSEC)
3994  * raised by eth device.
3995  */
3996 enum rte_eth_event_macsec_type {
3997 	/** Notifies unknown MACsec event. */
3998 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_MACSEC_UNKNOWN,
3999 	/** Notifies Sectag validation failure events. */
4000 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_MACSEC_SECTAG_VAL_ERR,
4001 	/** Notifies Rx SA hard expiry events. */
4002 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_MACSEC_RX_SA_PN_HARD_EXP,
4003 	/** Notifies Rx SA soft expiry events. */
4004 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_MACSEC_RX_SA_PN_SOFT_EXP,
4005 	/** Notifies Tx SA hard expiry events. */
4006 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_MACSEC_TX_SA_PN_HARD_EXP,
4007 	/** Notifies Tx SA soft events. */
4008 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_MACSEC_TX_SA_PN_SOFT_EXP,
4009 	/** Notifies Invalid SA event. */
4010 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_MACSEC_SA_NOT_VALID,
4011 };
4012 
4013 /**
4014  * Descriptor for @ref RTE_ETH_EVENT_MACSEC event.
4015  * Used by ethdev to send extra information of the MACsec offload event.
4016  */
4017 struct rte_eth_event_macsec_desc {
4018 	/** Type of RTE_ETH_EVENT_MACSEC_* event. */
4019 	enum rte_eth_event_macsec_type type;
4020 	/** Type of RTE_ETH_SUBEVENT_MACSEC_* subevent. */
4021 	enum rte_eth_event_macsec_subtype subtype;
4022 	/**
4023 	 * Event specific metadata.
4024 	 *
4025 	 * For the following events, *userdata* registered
4026 	 * with the *rte_security_session* would be returned
4027 	 * as metadata.
4028 	 *
4029 	 * @see struct rte_security_session_conf
4030 	 */
4031 	uint64_t metadata;
4032 };
4033 
4034 /**
4035  * Subtypes for IPsec offload event(@ref RTE_ETH_EVENT_IPSEC) raised by
4036  * eth device.
4037  */
4038 enum rte_eth_event_ipsec_subtype {
4039 	/**  PMD specific error start */
4040 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_IPSEC_PMD_ERROR_START = -256,
4041 	/**  PMD specific error end */
4042 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_IPSEC_PMD_ERROR_END = -1,
4043 	/** Unknown event type */
4044 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_IPSEC_UNKNOWN = 0,
4045 	/** Sequence number overflow */
4046 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_IPSEC_ESN_OVERFLOW,
4047 	/** Soft time expiry of SA */
4048 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_IPSEC_SA_TIME_EXPIRY,
4049 	/**
4050 	 * Soft byte expiry of SA determined by
4051 	 * @ref rte_security_ipsec_lifetime::bytes_soft_limit
4052 	 */
4053 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_IPSEC_SA_BYTE_EXPIRY,
4054 	/**
4055 	 * Soft packet expiry of SA determined by
4056 	 * @ref rte_security_ipsec_lifetime::packets_soft_limit
4057 	 */
4058 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_IPSEC_SA_PKT_EXPIRY,
4059 	/**
4060 	 * Hard byte expiry of SA determined by
4061 	 * @ref rte_security_ipsec_lifetime::bytes_hard_limit
4062 	 */
4063 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_IPSEC_SA_BYTE_HARD_EXPIRY,
4064 	/**
4065 	 * Hard packet expiry of SA determined by
4066 	 * @ref rte_security_ipsec_lifetime::packets_hard_limit
4067 	 */
4068 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_IPSEC_SA_PKT_HARD_EXPIRY,
4069 	/** Max value of this enum */
4070 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_IPSEC_MAX
4071 };
4072 
4073 /**
4074  * Descriptor for @ref RTE_ETH_EVENT_IPSEC event. Used by eth dev to send extra
4075  * information of the IPsec offload event.
4076  */
4077 struct rte_eth_event_ipsec_desc {
4078 	/** Type of RTE_ETH_EVENT_IPSEC_* event */
4079 	enum rte_eth_event_ipsec_subtype subtype;
4080 	/**
4081 	 * Event specific metadata.
4082 	 *
4083 	 * For the following events, *userdata* registered
4084 	 * with the *rte_security_session* would be returned
4085 	 * as metadata,
4086 	 *
4087 	 * - @ref RTE_ETH_EVENT_IPSEC_ESN_OVERFLOW
4088 	 * - @ref RTE_ETH_EVENT_IPSEC_SA_TIME_EXPIRY
4089 	 * - @ref RTE_ETH_EVENT_IPSEC_SA_BYTE_EXPIRY
4090 	 * - @ref RTE_ETH_EVENT_IPSEC_SA_PKT_EXPIRY
4091 	 * - @ref RTE_ETH_EVENT_IPSEC_SA_BYTE_HARD_EXPIRY
4092 	 * - @ref RTE_ETH_EVENT_IPSEC_SA_PKT_HARD_EXPIRY
4093 	 *
4094 	 * @see struct rte_security_session_conf
4095 	 *
4096 	 */
4097 	uint64_t metadata;
4098 };
4099 
4100 /**
4101  * The eth device event type for interrupt, and maybe others in the future.
4102  */
4103 enum rte_eth_event_type {
4104 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_UNKNOWN,  /**< unknown event type */
4105 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_INTR_LSC, /**< lsc interrupt event */
4106 	/** queue state event (enabled/disabled) */
4107 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_QUEUE_STATE,
4108 	/** reset interrupt event, sent to VF on PF reset */
4109 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_INTR_RESET,
4110 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_VF_MBOX,  /**< message from the VF received by PF */
4111 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_MACSEC,   /**< MACsec offload related event */
4112 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_INTR_RMV, /**< device removal event */
4113 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_NEW,      /**< port is probed */
4114 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_DESTROY,  /**< port is released */
4115 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_IPSEC,    /**< IPsec offload related event */
4116 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_FLOW_AGED,/**< New aged-out flows is detected */
4117 	/**
4118 	 * Number of available Rx descriptors is smaller than the threshold.
4119 	 * @see rte_eth_rx_avail_thresh_set()
4120 	 */
4121 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_RX_AVAIL_THRESH,
4122 	/** Port recovering from a hardware or firmware error.
4123 	 * If PMD supports proactive error recovery,
4124 	 * it should trigger this event to notify application
4125 	 * that it detected an error and the recovery is being started.
4126 	 * Upon receiving the event, the application should not invoke any control path API
4127 	 * (such as rte_eth_dev_configure/rte_eth_dev_stop...) until receiving
4128 	 * RTE_ETH_EVENT_RECOVERY_SUCCESS or RTE_ETH_EVENT_RECOVERY_FAILED event.
4129 	 * The PMD will set the data path pointers to dummy functions,
4130 	 * and re-set the data path pointers to non-dummy functions
4131 	 * before reporting RTE_ETH_EVENT_RECOVERY_SUCCESS event.
4132 	 * It means that the application cannot send or receive any packets
4133 	 * during this period.
4134 	 * @note Before the PMD reports the recovery result,
4135 	 * the PMD may report the RTE_ETH_EVENT_ERR_RECOVERING event again,
4136 	 * because a larger error may occur during the recovery.
4137 	 */
4138 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_ERR_RECOVERING,
4139 	/** Port recovers successfully from the error.
4140 	 * The PMD already re-configured the port,
4141 	 * and the effect is the same as a restart operation.
4142 	 * a) The following operation will be retained: (alphabetically)
4143 	 *    - DCB configuration
4144 	 *    - FEC configuration
4145 	 *    - Flow control configuration
4146 	 *    - LRO configuration
4147 	 *    - LSC configuration
4148 	 *    - MTU
4149 	 *    - MAC address (default and those supplied by MAC address array)
4150 	 *    - Promiscuous and allmulticast mode
4151 	 *    - PTP configuration
4152 	 *    - Queue (Rx/Tx) settings
4153 	 *    - Queue statistics mappings
4154 	 *    - RSS configuration by rte_eth_dev_rss_xxx() family
4155 	 *    - Rx checksum configuration
4156 	 *    - Rx interrupt settings
4157 	 *    - Traffic management configuration
4158 	 *    - VLAN configuration (including filtering, tpid, strip, pvid)
4159 	 *    - VMDq configuration
4160 	 * b) The following configuration maybe retained
4161 	 *    or not depending on the device capabilities:
4162 	 *    - flow rules
4163 	 *      (@see RTE_ETH_DEV_CAPA_FLOW_RULE_KEEP)
4164 	 *    - shared flow objects
4165 	 *      (@see RTE_ETH_DEV_CAPA_FLOW_SHARED_OBJECT_KEEP)
4166 	 * c) Any other configuration will not be stored
4167 	 *    and will need to be re-configured.
4168 	 */
4169 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_RECOVERY_SUCCESS,
4170 	/** Port recovery failed.
4171 	 * It means that the port should not be usable anymore.
4172 	 * The application should close the port.
4173 	 */
4174 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_RECOVERY_FAILED,
4175 	RTE_ETH_EVENT_MAX       /**< max value of this enum */
4176 };
4177 
4178 /**
4179  * User application callback to be registered for interrupts.
4180  *
4181  * Note: there is no guarantee in the DPDK drivers that a callback won't be
4182  *       called in the middle of other parts of the ethdev API. For example,
4183  *       imagine that thread A calls rte_eth_dev_start() and as part of this
4184  *       call, a RTE_ETH_EVENT_INTR_RESET event gets generated and the
4185  *       associated callback is ran on thread A. In that example, if the
4186  *       application protects its internal data using locks before calling
4187  *       rte_eth_dev_start(), and the callback takes a same lock, a deadlock
4188  *       occurs. Because of this, it is highly recommended NOT to take locks in
4189  *       those callbacks.
4190  */
4191 typedef int (*rte_eth_dev_cb_fn)(uint16_t port_id,
4192 		enum rte_eth_event_type event, void *cb_arg, void *ret_param);
4193 
4194 /**
4195  * Register a callback function for port event.
4196  *
4197  * @param port_id
4198  *  Port ID.
4199  *  RTE_ETH_ALL means register the event for all port ids.
4200  * @param event
4201  *  Event interested.
4202  * @param cb_fn
4203  *  User supplied callback function to be called.
4204  * @param cb_arg
4205  *  Pointer to the parameters for the registered callback.
4206  *
4207  * @return
4208  *  - On success, zero.
4209  *  - On failure, a negative value.
4210  */
4211 int rte_eth_dev_callback_register(uint16_t port_id,
4212 			enum rte_eth_event_type event,
4213 		rte_eth_dev_cb_fn cb_fn, void *cb_arg);
4214 
4215 /**
4216  * Unregister a callback function for port event.
4217  *
4218  * @param port_id
4219  *  Port ID.
4220  *  RTE_ETH_ALL means unregister the event for all port ids.
4221  * @param event
4222  *  Event interested.
4223  * @param cb_fn
4224  *  User supplied callback function to be called.
4225  * @param cb_arg
4226  *  Pointer to the parameters for the registered callback. -1 means to
4227  *  remove all for the same callback address and same event.
4228  *
4229  * @return
4230  *  - On success, zero.
4231  *  - On failure, a negative value.
4232  */
4233 int rte_eth_dev_callback_unregister(uint16_t port_id,
4234 			enum rte_eth_event_type event,
4235 		rte_eth_dev_cb_fn cb_fn, void *cb_arg);
4236 
4237 /**
4238  * When there is no Rx packet coming in Rx Queue for a long time, we can
4239  * sleep lcore related to Rx Queue for power saving, and enable Rx interrupt
4240  * to be triggered when Rx packet arrives.
4241  *
4242  * The rte_eth_dev_rx_intr_enable() function enables Rx queue
4243  * interrupt on specific Rx queue of a port.
4244  *
4245  * @param port_id
4246  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4247  * @param queue_id
4248  *   The index of the receive queue from which to retrieve input packets.
4249  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_rx_queue - 1] previously supplied
4250  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure().
4251  * @return
4252  *   - (0) if successful.
4253  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if underlying hardware OR driver doesn't support
4254  *     that operation.
4255  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
4256  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
4257  */
4258 int rte_eth_dev_rx_intr_enable(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id);
4259 
4260 /**
4261  * When lcore wakes up from Rx interrupt indicating packet coming, disable Rx
4262  * interrupt and returns to polling mode.
4263  *
4264  * The rte_eth_dev_rx_intr_disable() function disables Rx queue
4265  * interrupt on specific Rx queue of a port.
4266  *
4267  * @param port_id
4268  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4269  * @param queue_id
4270  *   The index of the receive queue from which to retrieve input packets.
4271  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_rx_queue - 1] previously supplied
4272  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure().
4273  * @return
4274  *   - (0) if successful.
4275  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if underlying hardware OR driver doesn't support
4276  *     that operation.
4277  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
4278  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
4279  */
4280 int rte_eth_dev_rx_intr_disable(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id);
4281 
4282 /**
4283  * Rx Interrupt control per port.
4284  *
4285  * @param port_id
4286  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4287  * @param epfd
4288  *   Epoll instance fd which the intr vector associated to.
4289  *   Using RTE_EPOLL_PER_THREAD allows to use per thread epoll instance.
4290  * @param op
4291  *   The operation be performed for the vector.
4292  *   Operation type of {RTE_INTR_EVENT_ADD, RTE_INTR_EVENT_DEL}.
4293  * @param data
4294  *   User raw data.
4295  * @return
4296  *   - On success, zero.
4297  *   - On failure, a negative value.
4298  */
4299 int rte_eth_dev_rx_intr_ctl(uint16_t port_id, int epfd, int op, void *data);
4300 
4301 /**
4302  * Rx Interrupt control per queue.
4303  *
4304  * @param port_id
4305  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4306  * @param queue_id
4307  *   The index of the receive queue from which to retrieve input packets.
4308  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_rx_queue - 1] previously supplied
4309  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure().
4310  * @param epfd
4311  *   Epoll instance fd which the intr vector associated to.
4312  *   Using RTE_EPOLL_PER_THREAD allows to use per thread epoll instance.
4313  * @param op
4314  *   The operation be performed for the vector.
4315  *   Operation type of {RTE_INTR_EVENT_ADD, RTE_INTR_EVENT_DEL}.
4316  * @param data
4317  *   User raw data.
4318  * @return
4319  *   - On success, zero.
4320  *   - On failure, a negative value.
4321  */
4322 int rte_eth_dev_rx_intr_ctl_q(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id,
4323 			      int epfd, int op, void *data);
4324 
4325 /**
4326  * Get interrupt fd per Rx queue.
4327  *
4328  * @param port_id
4329  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4330  * @param queue_id
4331  *   The index of the receive queue from which to retrieve input packets.
4332  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_rx_queue - 1] previously supplied
4333  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure().
4334  * @return
4335  *   - (>=0) the interrupt fd associated to the requested Rx queue if
4336  *           successful.
4337  *   - (-1) on error.
4338  */
4339 int
4340 rte_eth_dev_rx_intr_ctl_q_get_fd(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id);
4341 
4342 /**
4343  * Turn on the LED on the Ethernet device.
4344  * This function turns on the LED on the Ethernet device.
4345  *
4346  * @param port_id
4347  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4348  * @return
4349  *   - (0) if successful.
4350  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if underlying hardware OR driver doesn't support
4351  *     that operation.
4352  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
4353  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
4354  */
4355 int  rte_eth_led_on(uint16_t port_id);
4356 
4357 /**
4358  * Turn off the LED on the Ethernet device.
4359  * This function turns off the LED on the Ethernet device.
4360  *
4361  * @param port_id
4362  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4363  * @return
4364  *   - (0) if successful.
4365  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if underlying hardware OR driver doesn't support
4366  *     that operation.
4367  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
4368  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
4369  */
4370 int  rte_eth_led_off(uint16_t port_id);
4371 
4372 /**
4373  * @warning
4374  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
4375  *
4376  * Get Forward Error Correction(FEC) capability.
4377  *
4378  * @param port_id
4379  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4380  * @param speed_fec_capa
4381  *   speed_fec_capa is out only with per-speed capabilities.
4382  *   If set to NULL, the function returns the required number
4383  *   of required array entries.
4384  * @param num
4385  *   a number of elements in an speed_fec_capa array.
4386  *
4387  * @return
4388  *   - A non-negative value lower or equal to num: success. The return value
4389  *     is the number of entries filled in the fec capa array.
4390  *   - A non-negative value higher than num: error, the given fec capa array
4391  *     is too small. The return value corresponds to the num that should
4392  *     be given to succeed. The entries in fec capa array are not valid and
4393  *     shall not be used by the caller.
4394  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if underlying hardware OR driver doesn't support.
4395  *     that operation.
4396  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
4397  *   - (-ENODEV)  if *port_id* invalid.
4398  *   - (-EINVAL)  if *num* or *speed_fec_capa* invalid
4399  */
4400 __rte_experimental
4401 int rte_eth_fec_get_capability(uint16_t port_id,
4402 			       struct rte_eth_fec_capa *speed_fec_capa,
4403 			       unsigned int num);
4404 
4405 /**
4406  * @warning
4407  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
4408  *
4409  * Get current Forward Error Correction(FEC) mode.
4410  * If link is down and AUTO is enabled, AUTO is returned, otherwise,
4411  * configured FEC mode is returned.
4412  * If link is up, current FEC mode is returned.
4413  *
4414  * @param port_id
4415  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4416  * @param fec_capa
4417  *   A bitmask with the current FEC mode.
4418  * @return
4419  *   - (0) if successful.
4420  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if underlying hardware OR driver doesn't support.
4421  *     that operation.
4422  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
4423  *   - (-ENODEV)  if *port_id* invalid.
4424  */
4425 __rte_experimental
4426 int rte_eth_fec_get(uint16_t port_id, uint32_t *fec_capa);
4427 
4428 /**
4429  * @warning
4430  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
4431  *
4432  * Set Forward Error Correction(FEC) mode.
4433  *
4434  * @param port_id
4435  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4436  * @param fec_capa
4437  *   A bitmask of allowed FEC modes.
4438  *   If only the AUTO bit is set, the decision on which FEC
4439  *   mode to use will be made by HW/FW or driver.
4440  *   If the AUTO bit is set with some FEC modes, only specified
4441  *   FEC modes can be set.
4442  *   If AUTO bit is clear, specify FEC mode to be used
4443  *   (only one valid mode per speed may be set).
4444  * @return
4445  *   - (0) if successful.
4446  *   - (-EINVAL) if the FEC mode is not valid.
4447  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if underlying hardware OR driver doesn't support.
4448  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
4449  *   - (-ENODEV)  if *port_id* invalid.
4450  */
4451 __rte_experimental
4452 int rte_eth_fec_set(uint16_t port_id, uint32_t fec_capa);
4453 
4454 /**
4455  * Get current status of the Ethernet link flow control for Ethernet device
4456  *
4457  * @param port_id
4458  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4459  * @param fc_conf
4460  *   The pointer to the structure where to store the flow control parameters.
4461  * @return
4462  *   - (0) if successful.
4463  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support flow control.
4464  *   - (-ENODEV)  if *port_id* invalid.
4465  *   - (-EIO)  if device is removed.
4466  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
4467  */
4468 int rte_eth_dev_flow_ctrl_get(uint16_t port_id,
4469 			      struct rte_eth_fc_conf *fc_conf);
4470 
4471 /**
4472  * Configure the Ethernet link flow control for Ethernet device
4473  *
4474  * @param port_id
4475  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4476  * @param fc_conf
4477  *   The pointer to the structure of the flow control parameters.
4478  * @return
4479  *   - (0) if successful.
4480  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support flow control mode.
4481  *   - (-ENODEV)  if *port_id* invalid.
4482  *   - (-EINVAL)  if bad parameter
4483  *   - (-EIO)     if flow control setup failure or device is removed.
4484  */
4485 int rte_eth_dev_flow_ctrl_set(uint16_t port_id,
4486 			      struct rte_eth_fc_conf *fc_conf);
4487 
4488 /**
4489  * Configure the Ethernet priority flow control under DCB environment
4490  * for Ethernet device.
4491  *
4492  * @param port_id
4493  * The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4494  * @param pfc_conf
4495  * The pointer to the structure of the priority flow control parameters.
4496  * @return
4497  *   - (0) if successful.
4498  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support priority flow control mode.
4499  *   - (-ENODEV)  if *port_id* invalid.
4500  *   - (-EINVAL)  if bad parameter
4501  *   - (-EIO)     if flow control setup failure or device is removed.
4502  */
4503 int rte_eth_dev_priority_flow_ctrl_set(uint16_t port_id,
4504 				struct rte_eth_pfc_conf *pfc_conf);
4505 
4506 /**
4507  * Add a MAC address to the set used for filtering incoming packets.
4508  *
4509  * @param port_id
4510  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4511  * @param mac_addr
4512  *   The MAC address to add.
4513  * @param pool
4514  *   VMDq pool index to associate address with (if VMDq is enabled). If VMDq is
4515  *   not enabled, this should be set to 0.
4516  * @return
4517  *   - (0) if successfully added or *mac_addr* was already added.
4518  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support this feature.
4519  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port* is invalid.
4520  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
4521  *   - (-ENOSPC) if no more MAC addresses can be added.
4522  *   - (-EINVAL) if MAC address is invalid.
4523  */
4524 int rte_eth_dev_mac_addr_add(uint16_t port_id, struct rte_ether_addr *mac_addr,
4525 				uint32_t pool);
4526 
4527 /**
4528  * @warning
4529  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change without prior notice.
4530  *
4531  * Retrieve the information for queue based PFC.
4532  *
4533  * @param port_id
4534  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4535  * @param pfc_queue_info
4536  *   A pointer to a structure of type *rte_eth_pfc_queue_info* to be filled with
4537  *   the information about queue based PFC.
4538  * @return
4539  *   - (0) if successful.
4540  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if support for priority_flow_ctrl_queue_info_get does not exist.
4541  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
4542  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
4543  */
4544 __rte_experimental
4545 int rte_eth_dev_priority_flow_ctrl_queue_info_get(uint16_t port_id,
4546 		struct rte_eth_pfc_queue_info *pfc_queue_info);
4547 
4548 /**
4549  * @warning
4550  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change without prior notice.
4551  *
4552  * Configure the queue based priority flow control for a given queue
4553  * for Ethernet device.
4554  *
4555  * @note When an ethdev port switches to queue based PFC mode, the
4556  * unconfigured queues shall be configured by the driver with
4557  * default values such as lower priority value for TC etc.
4558  *
4559  * @param port_id
4560  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4561  * @param pfc_queue_conf
4562  *   The pointer to the structure of the priority flow control parameters
4563  *   for the queue.
4564  * @return
4565  *   - (0) if successful.
4566  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support queue based PFC mode.
4567  *   - (-ENODEV)  if *port_id* invalid.
4568  *   - (-EINVAL)  if bad parameter
4569  *   - (-EIO)     if flow control setup queue failure
4570  */
4571 __rte_experimental
4572 int rte_eth_dev_priority_flow_ctrl_queue_configure(uint16_t port_id,
4573 		struct rte_eth_pfc_queue_conf *pfc_queue_conf);
4574 
4575 /**
4576  * Remove a MAC address from the internal array of addresses.
4577  *
4578  * @param port_id
4579  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4580  * @param mac_addr
4581  *   MAC address to remove.
4582  * @return
4583  *   - (0) if successful, or *mac_addr* didn't exist.
4584  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support.
4585  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port* invalid.
4586  *   - (-EADDRINUSE) if attempting to remove the default MAC address.
4587  *   - (-EINVAL) if MAC address is invalid.
4588  */
4589 int rte_eth_dev_mac_addr_remove(uint16_t port_id,
4590 				struct rte_ether_addr *mac_addr);
4591 
4592 /**
4593  * Set the default MAC address.
4594  * It replaces the address at index 0 of the MAC address list.
4595  * If the address was already in the MAC address list,
4596  * please remove it first.
4597  *
4598  * @param port_id
4599  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4600  * @param mac_addr
4601  *   New default MAC address.
4602  * @return
4603  *   - (0) if successful, or *mac_addr* didn't exist.
4604  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support.
4605  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port* invalid.
4606  *   - (-EINVAL) if MAC address is invalid.
4607  *   - (-EEXIST) if MAC address was already in the address list.
4608  */
4609 int rte_eth_dev_default_mac_addr_set(uint16_t port_id,
4610 		struct rte_ether_addr *mac_addr);
4611 
4612 /**
4613  * Update Redirection Table(RETA) of Receive Side Scaling of Ethernet device.
4614  *
4615  * @param port_id
4616  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4617  * @param reta_conf
4618  *   RETA to update.
4619  * @param reta_size
4620  *   Redirection table size. The table size can be queried by
4621  *   rte_eth_dev_info_get().
4622  * @return
4623  *   - (0) if successful.
4624  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* is invalid.
4625  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support.
4626  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
4627  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
4628  */
4629 int rte_eth_dev_rss_reta_update(uint16_t port_id,
4630 				struct rte_eth_rss_reta_entry64 *reta_conf,
4631 				uint16_t reta_size);
4632 
4633 /**
4634  * Query Redirection Table(RETA) of Receive Side Scaling of Ethernet device.
4635  *
4636  * @param port_id
4637  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4638  * @param reta_conf
4639  *   RETA to query. For each requested reta entry, corresponding bit
4640  *   in mask must be set.
4641  * @param reta_size
4642  *   Redirection table size. The table size can be queried by
4643  *   rte_eth_dev_info_get().
4644  * @return
4645  *   - (0) if successful.
4646  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* is invalid.
4647  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support.
4648  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
4649  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
4650  */
4651 int rte_eth_dev_rss_reta_query(uint16_t port_id,
4652 			       struct rte_eth_rss_reta_entry64 *reta_conf,
4653 			       uint16_t reta_size);
4654 
4655 /**
4656  * Updates unicast hash table for receiving packet with the given destination
4657  * MAC address, and the packet is routed to all VFs for which the Rx mode is
4658  * accept packets that match the unicast hash table.
4659  *
4660  * @param port_id
4661  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4662  * @param addr
4663  *   Unicast MAC address.
4664  * @param on
4665  *    1 - Set an unicast hash bit for receiving packets with the MAC address.
4666  *    0 - Clear an unicast hash bit.
4667  * @return
4668  *   - (0) if successful.
4669  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support.
4670  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
4671  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
4672  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
4673  */
4674 int rte_eth_dev_uc_hash_table_set(uint16_t port_id, struct rte_ether_addr *addr,
4675 				  uint8_t on);
4676 
4677 /**
4678  * Updates all unicast hash bitmaps for receiving packet with any Unicast
4679  * Ethernet MAC addresses,the packet is routed to all VFs for which the Rx
4680  * mode is accept packets that match the unicast hash table.
4681  *
4682  * @param port_id
4683  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4684  * @param on
4685  *    1 - Set all unicast hash bitmaps for receiving all the Ethernet
4686  *         MAC addresses
4687  *    0 - Clear all unicast hash bitmaps
4688  * @return
4689  *   - (0) if successful.
4690  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support.
4691  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
4692  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
4693  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
4694  */
4695 int rte_eth_dev_uc_all_hash_table_set(uint16_t port_id, uint8_t on);
4696 
4697 /**
4698  * Set the rate limitation for a queue on an Ethernet device.
4699  *
4700  * @param port_id
4701  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4702  * @param queue_idx
4703  *   The queue ID.
4704  * @param tx_rate
4705  *   The Tx rate in Mbps. Allocated from the total port link speed.
4706  * @return
4707  *   - (0) if successful.
4708  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support this feature.
4709  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
4710  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
4711  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
4712  */
4713 int rte_eth_set_queue_rate_limit(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_idx,
4714 			uint32_t tx_rate);
4715 
4716 /**
4717  * Configuration of Receive Side Scaling hash computation of Ethernet device.
4718  *
4719  * @param port_id
4720  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4721  * @param rss_conf
4722  *   The new configuration to use for RSS hash computation on the port.
4723  * @return
4724  *   - (0) if successful.
4725  *   - (-ENODEV) if port identifier is invalid.
4726  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
4727  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support.
4728  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
4729  */
4730 int rte_eth_dev_rss_hash_update(uint16_t port_id,
4731 				struct rte_eth_rss_conf *rss_conf);
4732 
4733 /**
4734  * Retrieve current configuration of Receive Side Scaling hash computation
4735  * of Ethernet device.
4736  *
4737  * @param port_id
4738  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4739  * @param rss_conf
4740  *   Where to store the current RSS hash configuration of the Ethernet device.
4741  * @return
4742  *   - (0) if successful.
4743  *   - (-ENODEV) if port identifier is invalid.
4744  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
4745  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support RSS.
4746  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
4747  */
4748 int
4749 rte_eth_dev_rss_hash_conf_get(uint16_t port_id,
4750 			      struct rte_eth_rss_conf *rss_conf);
4751 
4752 /**
4753  * @warning
4754  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice.
4755  *
4756  *  Get the name of RSS hash algorithm.
4757  *
4758  * @param rss_algo
4759  *   Hash algorithm.
4760  *
4761  * @return
4762  *   Hash algorithm name or 'UNKNOWN' if the rss_algo cannot be recognized.
4763  */
4764 __rte_experimental
4765 const char *
4766 rte_eth_dev_rss_algo_name(enum rte_eth_hash_function rss_algo);
4767 
4768 /**
4769  * @warning
4770  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice.
4771  *
4772  * Get RSS hash algorithm by its name.
4773  *
4774  * @param name
4775  *   RSS hash algorithm.
4776  *
4777  * @param algo
4778  *   Return the RSS hash algorithm found, @see rte_eth_hash_function.
4779  *
4780  * @return
4781  *   - (0) if successful.
4782  *   - (-EINVAL) if not found.
4783  */
4784 __rte_experimental
4785 int
4786 rte_eth_find_rss_algo(const char *name, uint32_t *algo);
4787 
4788 /**
4789  * Add UDP tunneling port for a type of tunnel.
4790  *
4791  * Some NICs may require such configuration to properly parse a tunnel
4792  * with any standard or custom UDP port.
4793  * The packets with this UDP port will be parsed for this type of tunnel.
4794  * The device parser will also check the rest of the tunnel headers
4795  * before classifying the packet.
4796  *
4797  * With some devices, this API will affect packet classification, i.e.:
4798  *     - mbuf.packet_type reported on Rx
4799  *     - rte_flow rules with tunnel items
4800  *
4801  * @param port_id
4802  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4803  * @param tunnel_udp
4804  *   UDP tunneling configuration.
4805  *
4806  * @return
4807  *   - (0) if successful.
4808  *   - (-ENODEV) if port identifier is invalid.
4809  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
4810  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support tunnel type.
4811  */
4812 int
4813 rte_eth_dev_udp_tunnel_port_add(uint16_t port_id,
4814 				struct rte_eth_udp_tunnel *tunnel_udp);
4815 
4816 /**
4817  * Delete UDP tunneling port for a type of tunnel.
4818  *
4819  * The packets with this UDP port will not be classified as this type of tunnel
4820  * anymore if the device use such mapping for tunnel packet classification.
4821  *
4822  * @see rte_eth_dev_udp_tunnel_port_add
4823  *
4824  * @param port_id
4825  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4826  * @param tunnel_udp
4827  *   UDP tunneling configuration.
4828  *
4829  * @return
4830  *   - (0) if successful.
4831  *   - (-ENODEV) if port identifier is invalid.
4832  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
4833  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support tunnel type.
4834  */
4835 int
4836 rte_eth_dev_udp_tunnel_port_delete(uint16_t port_id,
4837 				   struct rte_eth_udp_tunnel *tunnel_udp);
4838 
4839 /**
4840  * Get DCB information on an Ethernet device.
4841  *
4842  * @param port_id
4843  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4844  * @param dcb_info
4845  *   DCB information.
4846  * @return
4847  *   - (0) if successful.
4848  *   - (-ENODEV) if port identifier is invalid.
4849  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
4850  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support.
4851  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
4852  */
4853 int rte_eth_dev_get_dcb_info(uint16_t port_id,
4854 			     struct rte_eth_dcb_info *dcb_info);
4855 
4856 struct rte_eth_rxtx_callback;
4857 
4858 /**
4859  * Add a callback to be called on packet Rx on a given port and queue.
4860  *
4861  * This API configures a function to be called for each burst of
4862  * packets received on a given NIC port queue. The return value is a pointer
4863  * that can be used to later remove the callback using
4864  * rte_eth_remove_rx_callback().
4865  *
4866  * Multiple functions are called in the order that they are added.
4867  *
4868  * @param port_id
4869  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4870  * @param queue_id
4871  *   The queue on the Ethernet device on which the callback is to be added.
4872  * @param fn
4873  *   The callback function
4874  * @param user_param
4875  *   A generic pointer parameter which will be passed to each invocation of the
4876  *   callback function on this port and queue. Inter-thread synchronization
4877  *   of any user data changes is the responsibility of the user.
4878  *
4879  * @return
4880  *   NULL on error.
4881  *   On success, a pointer value which can later be used to remove the callback.
4882  */
4883 const struct rte_eth_rxtx_callback *
4884 rte_eth_add_rx_callback(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id,
4885 		rte_rx_callback_fn fn, void *user_param);
4886 
4887 /**
4888  * Add a callback that must be called first on packet Rx on a given port
4889  * and queue.
4890  *
4891  * This API configures a first function to be called for each burst of
4892  * packets received on a given NIC port queue. The return value is a pointer
4893  * that can be used to later remove the callback using
4894  * rte_eth_remove_rx_callback().
4895  *
4896  * Multiple functions are called in the order that they are added.
4897  *
4898  * @param port_id
4899  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4900  * @param queue_id
4901  *   The queue on the Ethernet device on which the callback is to be added.
4902  * @param fn
4903  *   The callback function
4904  * @param user_param
4905  *   A generic pointer parameter which will be passed to each invocation of the
4906  *   callback function on this port and queue. Inter-thread synchronization
4907  *   of any user data changes is the responsibility of the user.
4908  *
4909  * @return
4910  *   NULL on error.
4911  *   On success, a pointer value which can later be used to remove the callback.
4912  */
4913 const struct rte_eth_rxtx_callback *
4914 rte_eth_add_first_rx_callback(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id,
4915 		rte_rx_callback_fn fn, void *user_param);
4916 
4917 /**
4918  * Add a callback to be called on packet Tx on a given port and queue.
4919  *
4920  * This API configures a function to be called for each burst of
4921  * packets sent on a given NIC port queue. The return value is a pointer
4922  * that can be used to later remove the callback using
4923  * rte_eth_remove_tx_callback().
4924  *
4925  * Multiple functions are called in the order that they are added.
4926  *
4927  * @param port_id
4928  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4929  * @param queue_id
4930  *   The queue on the Ethernet device on which the callback is to be added.
4931  * @param fn
4932  *   The callback function
4933  * @param user_param
4934  *   A generic pointer parameter which will be passed to each invocation of the
4935  *   callback function on this port and queue. Inter-thread synchronization
4936  *   of any user data changes is the responsibility of the user.
4937  *
4938  * @return
4939  *   NULL on error.
4940  *   On success, a pointer value which can later be used to remove the callback.
4941  */
4942 const struct rte_eth_rxtx_callback *
4943 rte_eth_add_tx_callback(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id,
4944 		rte_tx_callback_fn fn, void *user_param);
4945 
4946 /**
4947  * Remove an Rx packet callback from a given port and queue.
4948  *
4949  * This function is used to removed callbacks that were added to a NIC port
4950  * queue using rte_eth_add_rx_callback().
4951  *
4952  * Note: the callback is removed from the callback list but it isn't freed
4953  * since the it may still be in use. The memory for the callback can be
4954  * subsequently freed back by the application by calling rte_free():
4955  *
4956  * - Immediately - if the port is stopped, or the user knows that no
4957  *   callbacks are in flight e.g. if called from the thread doing Rx/Tx
4958  *   on that queue.
4959  *
4960  * - After a short delay - where the delay is sufficient to allow any
4961  *   in-flight callbacks to complete. Alternately, the RCU mechanism can be
4962  *   used to detect when data plane threads have ceased referencing the
4963  *   callback memory.
4964  *
4965  * @param port_id
4966  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
4967  * @param queue_id
4968  *   The queue on the Ethernet device from which the callback is to be removed.
4969  * @param user_cb
4970  *   User supplied callback created via rte_eth_add_rx_callback().
4971  *
4972  * @return
4973  *   - 0: Success. Callback was removed.
4974  *   - -ENODEV:  If *port_id* is invalid.
4975  *   - -ENOTSUP: Callback support is not available.
4976  *   - -EINVAL:  The queue_id is out of range, or the callback
4977  *               is NULL or not found for the port/queue.
4978  */
4979 int rte_eth_remove_rx_callback(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id,
4980 		const struct rte_eth_rxtx_callback *user_cb);
4981 
4982 /**
4983  * Remove a Tx packet callback from a given port and queue.
4984  *
4985  * This function is used to removed callbacks that were added to a NIC port
4986  * queue using rte_eth_add_tx_callback().
4987  *
4988  * Note: the callback is removed from the callback list but it isn't freed
4989  * since the it may still be in use. The memory for the callback can be
4990  * subsequently freed back by the application by calling rte_free():
4991  *
4992  * - Immediately - if the port is stopped, or the user knows that no
4993  *   callbacks are in flight e.g. if called from the thread doing Rx/Tx
4994  *   on that queue.
4995  *
4996  * - After a short delay - where the delay is sufficient to allow any
4997  *   in-flight callbacks to complete. Alternately, the RCU mechanism can be
4998  *   used to detect when data plane threads have ceased referencing the
4999  *   callback memory.
5000  *
5001  * @param port_id
5002  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5003  * @param queue_id
5004  *   The queue on the Ethernet device from which the callback is to be removed.
5005  * @param user_cb
5006  *   User supplied callback created via rte_eth_add_tx_callback().
5007  *
5008  * @return
5009  *   - 0: Success. Callback was removed.
5010  *   - -ENODEV:  If *port_id* is invalid.
5011  *   - -ENOTSUP: Callback support is not available.
5012  *   - -EINVAL:  The queue_id is out of range, or the callback
5013  *               is NULL or not found for the port/queue.
5014  */
5015 int rte_eth_remove_tx_callback(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id,
5016 		const struct rte_eth_rxtx_callback *user_cb);
5017 
5018 /**
5019  * Retrieve information about given port's Rx queue.
5020  *
5021  * @param port_id
5022  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5023  * @param queue_id
5024  *   The Rx queue on the Ethernet device for which information
5025  *   will be retrieved.
5026  * @param qinfo
5027  *   A pointer to a structure of type *rte_eth_rxq_info_info* to be filled with
5028  *   the information of the Ethernet device.
5029  *
5030  * @return
5031  *   - 0: Success
5032  *   - -ENODEV:  If *port_id* is invalid.
5033  *   - -ENOTSUP: routine is not supported by the device PMD.
5034  *   - -EINVAL:  The queue_id is out of range, or the queue
5035  *               is hairpin queue.
5036  */
5037 int rte_eth_rx_queue_info_get(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id,
5038 	struct rte_eth_rxq_info *qinfo);
5039 
5040 /**
5041  * Retrieve information about given port's Tx queue.
5042  *
5043  * @param port_id
5044  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5045  * @param queue_id
5046  *   The Tx queue on the Ethernet device for which information
5047  *   will be retrieved.
5048  * @param qinfo
5049  *   A pointer to a structure of type *rte_eth_txq_info_info* to be filled with
5050  *   the information of the Ethernet device.
5051  *
5052  * @return
5053  *   - 0: Success
5054  *   - -ENODEV:  If *port_id* is invalid.
5055  *   - -ENOTSUP: routine is not supported by the device PMD.
5056  *   - -EINVAL:  The queue_id is out of range, or the queue
5057  *               is hairpin queue.
5058  */
5059 int rte_eth_tx_queue_info_get(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id,
5060 	struct rte_eth_txq_info *qinfo);
5061 
5062 /**
5063  * @warning
5064  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
5065  *
5066  * Retrieve information about given ports's Rx queue for recycling mbufs.
5067  *
5068  * @param port_id
5069  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5070  * @param queue_id
5071  *   The Rx queue on the Ethernet devicefor which information
5072  *   will be retrieved.
5073  * @param recycle_rxq_info
5074  *   A pointer to a structure of type *rte_eth_recycle_rxq_info* to be filled.
5075  *
5076  * @return
5077  *   - 0: Success
5078  *   - -ENODEV:  If *port_id* is invalid.
5079  *   - -ENOTSUP: routine is not supported by the device PMD.
5080  *   - -EINVAL:  The queue_id is out of range.
5081  */
5082 __rte_experimental
5083 int rte_eth_recycle_rx_queue_info_get(uint16_t port_id,
5084 		uint16_t queue_id,
5085 		struct rte_eth_recycle_rxq_info *recycle_rxq_info);
5086 
5087 /**
5088  * Retrieve information about the Rx packet burst mode.
5089  *
5090  * @param port_id
5091  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5092  * @param queue_id
5093  *   The Rx queue on the Ethernet device for which information
5094  *   will be retrieved.
5095  * @param mode
5096  *   A pointer to a structure of type *rte_eth_burst_mode* to be filled
5097  *   with the information of the packet burst mode.
5098  *
5099  * @return
5100  *   - 0: Success
5101  *   - -ENODEV:  If *port_id* is invalid.
5102  *   - -ENOTSUP: routine is not supported by the device PMD.
5103  *   - -EINVAL:  The queue_id is out of range.
5104  */
5105 int rte_eth_rx_burst_mode_get(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id,
5106 	struct rte_eth_burst_mode *mode);
5107 
5108 /**
5109  * Retrieve information about the Tx packet burst mode.
5110  *
5111  * @param port_id
5112  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5113  * @param queue_id
5114  *   The Tx queue on the Ethernet device for which information
5115  *   will be retrieved.
5116  * @param mode
5117  *   A pointer to a structure of type *rte_eth_burst_mode* to be filled
5118  *   with the information of the packet burst mode.
5119  *
5120  * @return
5121  *   - 0: Success
5122  *   - -ENODEV:  If *port_id* is invalid.
5123  *   - -ENOTSUP: routine is not supported by the device PMD.
5124  *   - -EINVAL:  The queue_id is out of range.
5125  */
5126 int rte_eth_tx_burst_mode_get(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id,
5127 	struct rte_eth_burst_mode *mode);
5128 
5129 /**
5130  * @warning
5131  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change without prior notice.
5132  *
5133  * Retrieve the monitor condition for a given receive queue.
5134  *
5135  * @param port_id
5136  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5137  * @param queue_id
5138  *   The Rx queue on the Ethernet device for which information
5139  *   will be retrieved.
5140  * @param pmc
5141  *   The pointer to power-optimized monitoring condition structure.
5142  *
5143  * @return
5144  *   - 0: Success.
5145  *   -ENOTSUP: Operation not supported.
5146  *   -EINVAL: Invalid parameters.
5147  *   -ENODEV: Invalid port ID.
5148  */
5149 __rte_experimental
5150 int rte_eth_get_monitor_addr(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id,
5151 		struct rte_power_monitor_cond *pmc);
5152 
5153 /**
5154  * Retrieve the filtered device registers (values and names) and
5155  * register attributes (number of registers and register size)
5156  *
5157  * @param port_id
5158  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5159  * @param info
5160  *   Pointer to rte_dev_reg_info structure to fill in.
5161  *   - If info->filter is NULL, return info for all registers (seen as filter
5162  *     none).
5163  *   - If info->filter is not NULL, return error if the driver does not support
5164  *     filter. Fill the length field with filtered register number.
5165  *   - If info->data is NULL, the function fills in the width and length fields.
5166  *   - If info->data is not NULL, ethdev considers there are enough spaces to
5167  *     store the registers, and the values of registers with the filter string
5168  *     as the module name are put into the buffer pointed at by info->data.
5169  *   - If info->names is not NULL, drivers should fill it or the ethdev fills it
5170  *     with default names.
5171  * @return
5172  *   - (0) if successful.
5173  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support.
5174  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
5175  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
5176  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
5177  *   - others depends on the specific operations implementation.
5178  */
5179 __rte_experimental
5180 int rte_eth_dev_get_reg_info_ext(uint16_t port_id, struct rte_dev_reg_info *info);
5181 
5182 /**
5183  * Retrieve device registers and register attributes (number of registers and
5184  * register size)
5185  *
5186  * @param port_id
5187  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5188  * @param info
5189  *   Pointer to rte_dev_reg_info structure to fill in. If info->data is
5190  *   NULL the function fills in the width and length fields. If non-NULL
5191  *   the registers are put into the buffer pointed at by the data field.
5192  * @return
5193  *   - (0) if successful.
5194  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support.
5195  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
5196  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
5197  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
5198  *   - others depends on the specific operations implementation.
5199  */
5200 int rte_eth_dev_get_reg_info(uint16_t port_id, struct rte_dev_reg_info *info);
5201 
5202 /**
5203  * Retrieve size of device EEPROM
5204  *
5205  * @param port_id
5206  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5207  * @return
5208  *   - (>=0) EEPROM size if successful.
5209  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support.
5210  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
5211  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
5212  *   - others depends on the specific operations implementation.
5213  */
5214 int rte_eth_dev_get_eeprom_length(uint16_t port_id);
5215 
5216 /**
5217  * Retrieve EEPROM and EEPROM attribute
5218  *
5219  * @param port_id
5220  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5221  * @param info
5222  *   The template includes buffer for return EEPROM data and
5223  *   EEPROM attributes to be filled.
5224  * @return
5225  *   - (0) if successful.
5226  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support.
5227  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
5228  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
5229  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
5230  *   - others depends on the specific operations implementation.
5231  */
5232 int rte_eth_dev_get_eeprom(uint16_t port_id, struct rte_dev_eeprom_info *info);
5233 
5234 /**
5235  * Program EEPROM with provided data
5236  *
5237  * @param port_id
5238  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5239  * @param info
5240  *   The template includes EEPROM data for programming and
5241  *   EEPROM attributes to be filled
5242  * @return
5243  *   - (0) if successful.
5244  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support.
5245  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
5246  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
5247  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
5248  *   - others depends on the specific operations implementation.
5249  */
5250 int rte_eth_dev_set_eeprom(uint16_t port_id, struct rte_dev_eeprom_info *info);
5251 
5252 /**
5253  * @warning
5254  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change without prior notice.
5255  *
5256  * Retrieve the type and size of plugin module EEPROM
5257  *
5258  * @param port_id
5259  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5260  * @param modinfo
5261  *   The type and size of plugin module EEPROM.
5262  * @return
5263  *   - (0) if successful.
5264  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support.
5265  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
5266  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
5267  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
5268  *   - others depends on the specific operations implementation.
5269  */
5270 __rte_experimental
5271 int
5272 rte_eth_dev_get_module_info(uint16_t port_id,
5273 			    struct rte_eth_dev_module_info *modinfo);
5274 
5275 /**
5276  * @warning
5277  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change without prior notice.
5278  *
5279  * Retrieve the data of plugin module EEPROM
5280  *
5281  * @param port_id
5282  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5283  * @param info
5284  *   The template includes the plugin module EEPROM attributes, and the
5285  *   buffer for return plugin module EEPROM data.
5286  * @return
5287  *   - (0) if successful.
5288  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support.
5289  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
5290  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
5291  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
5292  *   - others depends on the specific operations implementation.
5293  */
5294 __rte_experimental
5295 int
5296 rte_eth_dev_get_module_eeprom(uint16_t port_id,
5297 			      struct rte_dev_eeprom_info *info);
5298 
5299 /**
5300  * Set the list of multicast addresses to filter on an Ethernet device.
5301  *
5302  * @param port_id
5303  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5304  * @param mc_addr_set
5305  *   The array of multicast addresses to set. Equal to NULL when the function
5306  *   is invoked to flush the set of filtered addresses.
5307  * @param nb_mc_addr
5308  *   The number of multicast addresses in the *mc_addr_set* array. Equal to 0
5309  *   when the function is invoked to flush the set of filtered addresses.
5310  * @return
5311  *   - (0) if successful.
5312  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
5313  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
5314  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if PMD of *port_id* doesn't support multicast filtering.
5315  *   - (-ENOSPC) if *port_id* has not enough multicast filtering resources.
5316  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
5317  */
5318 int rte_eth_dev_set_mc_addr_list(uint16_t port_id,
5319 				 struct rte_ether_addr *mc_addr_set,
5320 				 uint32_t nb_mc_addr);
5321 
5322 /**
5323  * Enable IEEE1588/802.1AS timestamping for an Ethernet device.
5324  *
5325  * @param port_id
5326  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5327  *
5328  * @return
5329  *   - 0: Success.
5330  *   - -ENODEV: The port ID is invalid.
5331  *   - -EIO: if device is removed.
5332  *   - -ENOTSUP: The function is not supported by the Ethernet driver.
5333  */
5334 int rte_eth_timesync_enable(uint16_t port_id);
5335 
5336 /**
5337  * Disable IEEE1588/802.1AS timestamping for an Ethernet device.
5338  *
5339  * @param port_id
5340  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5341  *
5342  * @return
5343  *   - 0: Success.
5344  *   - -ENODEV: The port ID is invalid.
5345  *   - -EIO: if device is removed.
5346  *   - -ENOTSUP: The function is not supported by the Ethernet driver.
5347  */
5348 int rte_eth_timesync_disable(uint16_t port_id);
5349 
5350 /**
5351  * Read an IEEE1588/802.1AS Rx timestamp from an Ethernet device.
5352  *
5353  * @param port_id
5354  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5355  * @param timestamp
5356  *   Pointer to the timestamp struct.
5357  * @param flags
5358  *   Device specific flags. Used to pass the Rx timesync register index to
5359  *   i40e. Unused in igb/ixgbe, pass 0 instead.
5360  *
5361  * @return
5362  *   - 0: Success.
5363  *   - -EINVAL: No timestamp is available.
5364  *   - -ENODEV: The port ID is invalid.
5365  *   - -EIO: if device is removed.
5366  *   - -ENOTSUP: The function is not supported by the Ethernet driver.
5367  */
5368 int rte_eth_timesync_read_rx_timestamp(uint16_t port_id,
5369 		struct timespec *timestamp, uint32_t flags);
5370 
5371 /**
5372  * Read an IEEE1588/802.1AS Tx timestamp from an Ethernet device.
5373  *
5374  * @param port_id
5375  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5376  * @param timestamp
5377  *   Pointer to the timestamp struct.
5378  *
5379  * @return
5380  *   - 0: Success.
5381  *   - -EINVAL: No timestamp is available.
5382  *   - -ENODEV: The port ID is invalid.
5383  *   - -EIO: if device is removed.
5384  *   - -ENOTSUP: The function is not supported by the Ethernet driver.
5385  */
5386 int rte_eth_timesync_read_tx_timestamp(uint16_t port_id,
5387 		struct timespec *timestamp);
5388 
5389 /**
5390  * Adjust the timesync clock on an Ethernet device.
5391  *
5392  * This is usually used in conjunction with other Ethdev timesync functions to
5393  * synchronize the device time using the IEEE1588/802.1AS protocol.
5394  *
5395  * @param port_id
5396  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5397  * @param delta
5398  *   The adjustment in nanoseconds.
5399  *
5400  * @return
5401  *   - 0: Success.
5402  *   - -ENODEV: The port ID is invalid.
5403  *   - -EIO: if device is removed.
5404  *   - -ENOTSUP: The function is not supported by the Ethernet driver.
5405  */
5406 int rte_eth_timesync_adjust_time(uint16_t port_id, int64_t delta);
5407 
5408 /**
5409  * Adjust the clock frequency on an Ethernet device.
5410  *
5411  * Adjusts the base frequency by a specified percentage of ppm (parts per
5412  * million). This is usually used in conjunction with other Ethdev timesync
5413  * functions to synchronize the device time using the IEEE1588/802.1AS
5414  * protocol.
5415  *
5416  * The clock is subject to frequency deviation and rate of change drift due to
5417  * the environment. The upper layer APP calculates the frequency compensation
5418  * value of the slave clock relative to the master clock via a servo algorithm
5419  * and adjusts the device clock frequency via "rte_eth_timesync_adjust_freq()".
5420  * Commonly used servo algorithms are pi/linreg/ntpshm, for implementation
5421  * see: https://github.com/nxp-archive/openil_linuxptp.git.
5422  *
5423  * The adjustment value obtained by the servo algorithm is usually in
5424  * ppb (parts per billion). For consistency with the kernel driver .adjfine,
5425  * the tuning values are in ppm. Note that 1 ppb is approximately 65.536 scaled
5426  * ppm, see Linux kernel upstream commit 1060707e3809 (‘ptp: introduce helpers
5427  * to adjust by scaled parts per million’).
5428  *
5429  * In addition, the device reference frequency is usually also the stepping
5430  * threshold for the servo algorithm, and the frequency up and down adjustment
5431  * range is limited by the device. The device clock frequency should be
5432  * adjusted with "rte_eth_timesync_adjust_freq()" every time the clock is
5433  * synchronised. Also use ‘rte_eth_timesync_adjust_time()’ to update the device
5434  * clock only if the absolute value of the master/slave clock offset is greater than
5435  * or equal to the step threshold.
5436  *
5437  * @param port_id
5438  *  The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5439  * @param ppm
5440  *  Parts per million with 16-bit fractional field
5441  *
5442  * @return
5443  *   - 0: Success.
5444  *   - -ENODEV: The port ID is invalid.
5445  *   - -EIO: if device is removed.
5446  *   - -ENOTSUP: The function is not supported by the Ethernet driver.
5447  */
5448 __rte_experimental
5449 int rte_eth_timesync_adjust_freq(uint16_t port_id, int64_t ppm);
5450 
5451 /**
5452  * Read the time from the timesync clock on an Ethernet device.
5453  *
5454  * This is usually used in conjunction with other Ethdev timesync functions to
5455  * synchronize the device time using the IEEE1588/802.1AS protocol.
5456  *
5457  * @param port_id
5458  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5459  * @param time
5460  *   Pointer to the timespec struct that holds the time.
5461  *
5462  * @return
5463  *   - 0: Success.
5464  *   - -EINVAL: Bad parameter.
5465  */
5466 int rte_eth_timesync_read_time(uint16_t port_id, struct timespec *time);
5467 
5468 /**
5469  * Set the time of the timesync clock on an Ethernet device.
5470  *
5471  * This is usually used in conjunction with other Ethdev timesync functions to
5472  * synchronize the device time using the IEEE1588/802.1AS protocol.
5473  *
5474  * @param port_id
5475  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5476  * @param time
5477  *   Pointer to the timespec struct that holds the time.
5478  *
5479  * @return
5480  *   - 0: Success.
5481  *   - -EINVAL: No timestamp is available.
5482  *   - -ENODEV: The port ID is invalid.
5483  *   - -EIO: if device is removed.
5484  *   - -ENOTSUP: The function is not supported by the Ethernet driver.
5485  */
5486 int rte_eth_timesync_write_time(uint16_t port_id, const struct timespec *time);
5487 
5488 /**
5489  * @warning
5490  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change without prior notice.
5491  *
5492  * Read the current clock counter of an Ethernet device
5493  *
5494  * This returns the current raw clock value of an Ethernet device. It is
5495  * a raw amount of ticks, with no given time reference.
5496  * The value returned here is from the same clock than the one
5497  * filling timestamp field of Rx packets when using hardware timestamp
5498  * offload. Therefore it can be used to compute a precise conversion of
5499  * the device clock to the real time.
5500  *
5501  * E.g, a simple heuristic to derivate the frequency would be:
5502  * uint64_t start, end;
5503  * rte_eth_read_clock(port, start);
5504  * rte_delay_ms(100);
5505  * rte_eth_read_clock(port, end);
5506  * double freq = (end - start) * 10;
5507  *
5508  * Compute a common reference with:
5509  * uint64_t base_time_sec = current_time();
5510  * uint64_t base_clock;
5511  * rte_eth_read_clock(port, base_clock);
5512  *
5513  * Then, convert the raw mbuf timestamp with:
5514  * base_time_sec + (double)(*timestamp_dynfield(mbuf) - base_clock) / freq;
5515  *
5516  * This simple example will not provide a very good accuracy. One must
5517  * at least measure multiple times the frequency and do a regression.
5518  * To avoid deviation from the system time, the common reference can
5519  * be repeated from time to time. The integer division can also be
5520  * converted by a multiplication and a shift for better performance.
5521  *
5522  * @param port_id
5523  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5524  * @param clock
5525  *   Pointer to the uint64_t that holds the raw clock value.
5526  *
5527  * @return
5528  *   - 0: Success.
5529  *   - -ENODEV: The port ID is invalid.
5530  *   - -ENOTSUP: The function is not supported by the Ethernet driver.
5531  *   - -EINVAL: if bad parameter.
5532  */
5533 __rte_experimental
5534 int
5535 rte_eth_read_clock(uint16_t port_id, uint64_t *clock);
5536 
5537 /**
5538  * Get the port ID from device name.
5539  * The device name should be specified as below:
5540  * - PCIe address (Domain:Bus:Device.Function), for example- 0000:2:00.0
5541  * - SoC device name, for example- fsl-gmac0
5542  * - vdev dpdk name, for example- net_[pcap0|null0|tap0]
5543  *
5544  * @param name
5545  *   PCI address or name of the device.
5546  * @param port_id
5547  *   Pointer to port identifier of the device.
5548  * @return
5549  *   - (0) if successful and port_id is filled.
5550  *   - (-ENODEV or -EINVAL) on failure.
5551  */
5552 int
5553 rte_eth_dev_get_port_by_name(const char *name, uint16_t *port_id);
5554 
5555 /**
5556  * Get the device name from port ID.
5557  * The device name is specified as below:
5558  * - PCIe address (Domain:Bus:Device.Function), for example- 0000:02:00.0
5559  * - SoC device name, for example- fsl-gmac0
5560  * - vdev dpdk name, for example- net_[pcap0|null0|tun0|tap0]
5561  *
5562  * @param port_id
5563  *   Port identifier of the device.
5564  * @param name
5565  *   Buffer of size RTE_ETH_NAME_MAX_LEN to store the name.
5566  * @return
5567  *   - (0) if successful.
5568  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* is invalid.
5569  *   - (-EINVAL) on failure.
5570  */
5571 int
5572 rte_eth_dev_get_name_by_port(uint16_t port_id, char *name);
5573 
5574 /**
5575  * Check that numbers of Rx and Tx descriptors satisfy descriptors limits from
5576  * the Ethernet device information, otherwise adjust them to boundaries.
5577  *
5578  * @param port_id
5579  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5580  * @param nb_rx_desc
5581  *   A pointer to a uint16_t where the number of receive
5582  *   descriptors stored.
5583  * @param nb_tx_desc
5584  *   A pointer to a uint16_t where the number of transmit
5585  *   descriptors stored.
5586  * @return
5587  *   - (0) if successful.
5588  *   - (-ENOTSUP, -ENODEV or -EINVAL) on failure.
5589  */
5590 int rte_eth_dev_adjust_nb_rx_tx_desc(uint16_t port_id,
5591 				     uint16_t *nb_rx_desc,
5592 				     uint16_t *nb_tx_desc);
5593 
5594 /**
5595  * Test if a port supports specific mempool ops.
5596  *
5597  * @param port_id
5598  *   Port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5599  * @param [in] pool
5600  *   The name of the pool operations to test.
5601  * @return
5602  *   - 0: best mempool ops choice for this port.
5603  *   - 1: mempool ops are supported for this port.
5604  *   - -ENOTSUP: mempool ops not supported for this port.
5605  *   - -ENODEV: Invalid port Identifier.
5606  *   - -EINVAL: Pool param is null.
5607  */
5608 int
5609 rte_eth_dev_pool_ops_supported(uint16_t port_id, const char *pool);
5610 
5611 /**
5612  * Get the security context for the Ethernet device.
5613  *
5614  * @param port_id
5615  *   Port identifier of the Ethernet device
5616  * @return
5617  *   - NULL on error.
5618  *   - pointer to security context on success.
5619  */
5620 void *
5621 rte_eth_dev_get_sec_ctx(uint16_t port_id);
5622 
5623 /**
5624  * @warning
5625  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
5626  *
5627  * Query the device hairpin capabilities.
5628  *
5629  * @param port_id
5630  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5631  * @param cap
5632  *   Pointer to a structure that will hold the hairpin capabilities.
5633  * @return
5634  *   - (0) if successful.
5635  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if hardware doesn't support.
5636  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
5637  */
5638 __rte_experimental
5639 int rte_eth_dev_hairpin_capability_get(uint16_t port_id,
5640 				       struct rte_eth_hairpin_cap *cap);
5641 
5642 /**
5643  * @warning
5644  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this structure may change without prior notice.
5645  *
5646  * Ethernet device representor ID range entry
5647  */
5648 struct rte_eth_representor_range {
5649 	enum rte_eth_representor_type type; /**< Representor type */
5650 	int controller; /**< Controller index */
5651 	int pf; /**< Physical function index */
5652 	__extension__
5653 	union {
5654 		int vf; /**< VF start index */
5655 		int sf; /**< SF start index */
5656 	};
5657 	uint32_t id_base; /**< Representor ID start index */
5658 	uint32_t id_end;  /**< Representor ID end index */
5659 	char name[RTE_DEV_NAME_MAX_LEN]; /**< Representor name */
5660 };
5661 
5662 /**
5663  * @warning
5664  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this structure may change without prior notice.
5665  *
5666  * Ethernet device representor information
5667  */
5668 struct rte_eth_representor_info {
5669 	uint16_t controller; /**< Controller ID of caller device. */
5670 	uint16_t pf; /**< Physical function ID of caller device. */
5671 	uint32_t nb_ranges_alloc; /**< Size of the ranges array. */
5672 	uint32_t nb_ranges; /**< Number of initialized ranges. */
5673 	struct rte_eth_representor_range ranges[];/**< Representor ID range. */
5674 };
5675 
5676 /**
5677  * Retrieve the representor info of the device.
5678  *
5679  * Get device representor info to be able to calculate a unique
5680  * representor ID. @see rte_eth_representor_id_get helper.
5681  *
5682  * @param port_id
5683  *   The port identifier of the device.
5684  * @param info
5685  *   A pointer to a representor info structure.
5686  *   NULL to return number of range entries and allocate memory
5687  *   for next call to store detail.
5688  *   The number of ranges that were written into this structure
5689  *   will be placed into its nb_ranges field. This number cannot be
5690  *   larger than the nb_ranges_alloc that by the user before calling
5691  *   this function. It can be smaller than the value returned by the
5692  *   function, however.
5693  * @return
5694  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if operation is not supported.
5695  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
5696  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
5697  *   - (>=0) number of available representor range entries.
5698  */
5699 __rte_experimental
5700 int rte_eth_representor_info_get(uint16_t port_id,
5701 				 struct rte_eth_representor_info *info);
5702 
5703 /** The NIC is able to deliver flag (if set) with packets to the PMD. */
5704 #define RTE_ETH_RX_METADATA_USER_FLAG RTE_BIT64(0)
5705 
5706 /** The NIC is able to deliver mark ID with packets to the PMD. */
5707 #define RTE_ETH_RX_METADATA_USER_MARK RTE_BIT64(1)
5708 
5709 /** The NIC is able to deliver tunnel ID with packets to the PMD. */
5710 #define RTE_ETH_RX_METADATA_TUNNEL_ID RTE_BIT64(2)
5711 
5712 /**
5713  * Negotiate the NIC's ability to deliver specific kinds of metadata to the PMD.
5714  *
5715  * Invoke this API before the first rte_eth_dev_configure() invocation
5716  * to let the PMD make preparations that are inconvenient to do later.
5717  *
5718  * The negotiation process is as follows:
5719  *
5720  * - the application requests features intending to use at least some of them;
5721  * - the PMD responds with the guaranteed subset of the requested feature set;
5722  * - the application can retry negotiation with another set of features;
5723  * - the application can pass zero to clear the negotiation result;
5724  * - the last negotiated result takes effect upon
5725  *   the ethdev configure and start.
5726  *
5727  * @note
5728  *   The PMD is supposed to first consider enabling the requested feature set
5729  *   in its entirety. Only if it fails to do so, does it have the right to
5730  *   respond with a smaller set of the originally requested features.
5731  *
5732  * @note
5733  *   Return code (-ENOTSUP) does not necessarily mean that the requested
5734  *   features are unsupported. In this case, the application should just
5735  *   assume that these features can be used without prior negotiations.
5736  *
5737  * @param port_id
5738  *   Port (ethdev) identifier
5739  *
5740  * @param[inout] features
5741  *   Feature selection buffer
5742  *
5743  * @return
5744  *   - (-EBUSY) if the port can't handle this in its current state;
5745  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if the method itself is not supported by the PMD;
5746  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* is invalid;
5747  *   - (-EINVAL) if *features* is NULL;
5748  *   - (-EIO) if the device is removed;
5749  *   - (0) on success
5750  */
5751 int rte_eth_rx_metadata_negotiate(uint16_t port_id, uint64_t *features);
5752 
5753 /** Flag to offload IP reassembly for IPv4 packets. */
5754 #define RTE_ETH_DEV_REASSEMBLY_F_IPV4 (RTE_BIT32(0))
5755 /** Flag to offload IP reassembly for IPv6 packets. */
5756 #define RTE_ETH_DEV_REASSEMBLY_F_IPV6 (RTE_BIT32(1))
5757 
5758 /**
5759  * A structure used to get/set IP reassembly configuration. It is also used
5760  * to get the maximum capability values that a PMD can support.
5761  *
5762  * If rte_eth_ip_reassembly_capability_get() returns 0, IP reassembly can be
5763  * enabled using rte_eth_ip_reassembly_conf_set() and params values lower than
5764  * capability params can be set in the PMD.
5765  */
5766 struct rte_eth_ip_reassembly_params {
5767 	/** Maximum time in ms which PMD can wait for other fragments. */
5768 	uint32_t timeout_ms;
5769 	/** Maximum number of fragments that can be reassembled. */
5770 	uint16_t max_frags;
5771 	/**
5772 	 * Flags to enable reassembly of packet types -
5773 	 * RTE_ETH_DEV_REASSEMBLY_F_xxx.
5774 	 */
5775 	uint16_t flags;
5776 };
5777 
5778 /**
5779  * @warning
5780  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change without prior notice
5781  *
5782  * Get IP reassembly capabilities supported by the PMD. This is the first API
5783  * to be called for enabling the IP reassembly offload feature. PMD will return
5784  * the maximum values of parameters that PMD can support and user can call
5785  * rte_eth_ip_reassembly_conf_set() with param values lower than capability.
5786  *
5787  * @param port_id
5788  *   The port identifier of the device.
5789  * @param capa
5790  *   A pointer to rte_eth_ip_reassembly_params structure.
5791  * @return
5792  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if offload configuration is not supported by device.
5793  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
5794  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
5795  *   - (-EINVAL) if device is not configured or *capa* passed is NULL.
5796  *   - (0) on success.
5797  */
5798 __rte_experimental
5799 int rte_eth_ip_reassembly_capability_get(uint16_t port_id,
5800 		struct rte_eth_ip_reassembly_params *capa);
5801 
5802 /**
5803  * @warning
5804  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change without prior notice
5805  *
5806  * Get IP reassembly configuration parameters currently set in PMD.
5807  * The API will return error if the configuration is not already
5808  * set using rte_eth_ip_reassembly_conf_set() before calling this API or if
5809  * the device is not configured.
5810  *
5811  * @param port_id
5812  *   The port identifier of the device.
5813  * @param conf
5814  *   A pointer to rte_eth_ip_reassembly_params structure.
5815  * @return
5816  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if offload configuration is not supported by device.
5817  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
5818  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
5819  *   - (-EINVAL) if device is not configured or if *conf* passed is NULL or if
5820  *              configuration is not set using rte_eth_ip_reassembly_conf_set().
5821  *   - (0) on success.
5822  */
5823 __rte_experimental
5824 int rte_eth_ip_reassembly_conf_get(uint16_t port_id,
5825 		struct rte_eth_ip_reassembly_params *conf);
5826 
5827 /**
5828  * @warning
5829  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change without prior notice
5830  *
5831  * Set IP reassembly configuration parameters if the PMD supports IP reassembly
5832  * offload. User should first call rte_eth_ip_reassembly_capability_get() to
5833  * check the maximum values supported by the PMD before setting the
5834  * configuration. The use of this API is mandatory to enable this feature and
5835  * should be called before rte_eth_dev_start().
5836  *
5837  * In datapath, PMD cannot guarantee that IP reassembly is always successful.
5838  * Hence, PMD shall register mbuf dynamic field and dynamic flag using
5839  * rte_eth_ip_reassembly_dynfield_register() to denote incomplete IP reassembly.
5840  * If dynfield is not successfully registered, error will be returned and
5841  * IP reassembly offload cannot be used.
5842  *
5843  * @param port_id
5844  *   The port identifier of the device.
5845  * @param conf
5846  *   A pointer to rte_eth_ip_reassembly_params structure.
5847  * @return
5848  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if offload configuration is not supported by device.
5849  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
5850  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
5851  *   - (-EINVAL) if device is not configured or if device is already started or
5852  *               if *conf* passed is NULL or if mbuf dynfield is not registered
5853  *               successfully by the PMD.
5854  *   - (0) on success.
5855  */
5856 __rte_experimental
5857 int rte_eth_ip_reassembly_conf_set(uint16_t port_id,
5858 		const struct rte_eth_ip_reassembly_params *conf);
5859 
5860 /**
5861  * In case of IP reassembly offload failure, packet will be updated with
5862  * dynamic flag - RTE_MBUF_DYNFLAG_IP_REASSEMBLY_INCOMPLETE_NAME and packets
5863  * will be returned without alteration.
5864  * The application can retrieve the attached fragments using mbuf dynamic field
5865  * RTE_MBUF_DYNFIELD_IP_REASSEMBLY_NAME.
5866  */
5867 typedef struct {
5868 	/**
5869 	 * Next fragment packet. Application should fetch dynamic field of
5870 	 * each fragment until a NULL is received and nb_frags is 0.
5871 	 */
5872 	struct rte_mbuf *next_frag;
5873 	/** Time spent(in ms) by HW in waiting for further fragments. */
5874 	uint16_t time_spent;
5875 	/** Number of more fragments attached in mbuf dynamic fields. */
5876 	uint16_t nb_frags;
5877 } rte_eth_ip_reassembly_dynfield_t;
5878 
5879 /**
5880  * @warning
5881  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
5882  *
5883  * Dump private info from device to a file. Provided data and the order depends
5884  * on the PMD.
5885  *
5886  * @param port_id
5887  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5888  * @param file
5889  *   A pointer to a file for output.
5890  * @return
5891  *   - (0) on success.
5892  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* is invalid.
5893  *   - (-EINVAL) if null file.
5894  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if the device does not support this function.
5895  *   - (-EIO) if device is removed.
5896  */
5897 __rte_experimental
5898 int rte_eth_dev_priv_dump(uint16_t port_id, FILE *file);
5899 
5900 /**
5901  * @warning
5902  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
5903  *
5904  * Dump ethdev Rx descriptor info to a file.
5905  *
5906  * This API is used for debugging, not a dataplane API.
5907  *
5908  * @param port_id
5909  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5910  * @param queue_id
5911  *   A Rx queue identifier on this port.
5912  * @param offset
5913  *  The offset of the descriptor starting from tail. (0 is the next
5914  *  packet to be received by the driver).
5915  * @param num
5916  *   The number of the descriptors to dump.
5917  * @param file
5918  *   A pointer to a file for output.
5919  * @return
5920  *   - On success, zero.
5921  *   - On failure, a negative value.
5922  */
5923 __rte_experimental
5924 int rte_eth_rx_descriptor_dump(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id,
5925 			       uint16_t offset, uint16_t num, FILE *file);
5926 
5927 /**
5928  * @warning
5929  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
5930  *
5931  * Dump ethdev Tx descriptor info to a file.
5932  *
5933  * This API is used for debugging, not a dataplane API.
5934  *
5935  * @param port_id
5936  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
5937  * @param queue_id
5938  *   A Tx queue identifier on this port.
5939  * @param offset
5940  *  The offset of the descriptor starting from tail. (0 is the place where
5941  *  the next packet will be send).
5942  * @param num
5943  *   The number of the descriptors to dump.
5944  * @param file
5945  *   A pointer to a file for output.
5946  * @return
5947  *   - On success, zero.
5948  *   - On failure, a negative value.
5949  */
5950 __rte_experimental
5951 int rte_eth_tx_descriptor_dump(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id,
5952 			       uint16_t offset, uint16_t num, FILE *file);
5953 
5954 
5955 /* Congestion management */
5956 
5957 /** Enumerate list of ethdev congestion management objects */
5958 enum rte_eth_cman_obj {
5959 	/** Congestion management based on Rx queue depth */
5960 	RTE_ETH_CMAN_OBJ_RX_QUEUE = RTE_BIT32(0),
5961 	/**
5962 	 * Congestion management based on mempool depth associated with Rx queue
5963 	 * @see rte_eth_rx_queue_setup()
5964 	 */
5965 	RTE_ETH_CMAN_OBJ_RX_QUEUE_MEMPOOL = RTE_BIT32(1),
5966 };
5967 
5968 /**
5969  * @warning
5970  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this structure may change, or be removed, without prior notice
5971  *
5972  * A structure used to retrieve information of ethdev congestion management.
5973  */
5974 struct rte_eth_cman_info {
5975 	/**
5976 	 * Set of supported congestion management modes
5977 	 * @see enum rte_cman_mode
5978 	 */
5979 	uint64_t modes_supported;
5980 	/**
5981 	 * Set of supported congestion management objects
5982 	 * @see enum rte_eth_cman_obj
5983 	 */
5984 	uint64_t objs_supported;
5985 	/**
5986 	 * Reserved for future fields. Always returned as 0 when
5987 	 * rte_eth_cman_info_get() is invoked
5988 	 */
5989 	uint8_t rsvd[8];
5990 };
5991 
5992 /**
5993  * @warning
5994  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this structure may change, or be removed, without prior notice
5995  *
5996  * A structure used to configure the ethdev congestion management.
5997  */
5998 struct rte_eth_cman_config {
5999 	/** Congestion management object */
6000 	enum rte_eth_cman_obj obj;
6001 	/** Congestion management mode */
6002 	enum rte_cman_mode mode;
6003 	union {
6004 		/**
6005 		 * Rx queue to configure congestion management.
6006 		 *
6007 		 * Valid when object is RTE_ETH_CMAN_OBJ_RX_QUEUE or
6008 		 * RTE_ETH_CMAN_OBJ_RX_QUEUE_MEMPOOL.
6009 		 */
6010 		uint16_t rx_queue;
6011 		/**
6012 		 * Reserved for future fields.
6013 		 * It must be set to 0 when rte_eth_cman_config_set() is invoked
6014 		 * and will be returned as 0 when rte_eth_cman_config_get() is
6015 		 * invoked.
6016 		 */
6017 		uint8_t rsvd_obj_params[4];
6018 	} obj_param;
6019 	union {
6020 		/**
6021 		 * RED configuration parameters.
6022 		 *
6023 		 * Valid when mode is RTE_CMAN_RED.
6024 		 */
6025 		struct rte_cman_red_params red;
6026 		/**
6027 		 * Reserved for future fields.
6028 		 * It must be set to 0 when rte_eth_cman_config_set() is invoked
6029 		 * and will be returned as 0 when rte_eth_cman_config_get() is
6030 		 * invoked.
6031 		 */
6032 		uint8_t rsvd_mode_params[4];
6033 	} mode_param;
6034 };
6035 
6036 /**
6037  * @warning
6038  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
6039  *
6040  * Retrieve the information for ethdev congestion management
6041  *
6042  * @param port_id
6043  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
6044  * @param info
6045  *   A pointer to a structure of type *rte_eth_cman_info* to be filled with
6046  *   the information about congestion management.
6047  * @return
6048  *   - (0) if successful.
6049  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if support for cman_info_get does not exist.
6050  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
6051  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
6052  */
6053 __rte_experimental
6054 int rte_eth_cman_info_get(uint16_t port_id, struct rte_eth_cman_info *info);
6055 
6056 /**
6057  * @warning
6058  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
6059  *
6060  * Initialize the ethdev congestion management configuration structure with default values.
6061  *
6062  * @param port_id
6063  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
6064  * @param config
6065  *   A pointer to a structure of type *rte_eth_cman_config* to be initialized
6066  *   with default value.
6067  * @return
6068  *   - (0) if successful.
6069  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if support for cman_config_init does not exist.
6070  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
6071  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
6072  */
6073 __rte_experimental
6074 int rte_eth_cman_config_init(uint16_t port_id, struct rte_eth_cman_config *config);
6075 
6076 /**
6077  * @warning
6078  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
6079  *
6080  * Configure ethdev congestion management
6081  *
6082  * @param port_id
6083  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
6084  * @param config
6085  *   A pointer to a structure of type *rte_eth_cman_config* to be configured.
6086  * @return
6087  *   - (0) if successful.
6088  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if support for cman_config_set does not exist.
6089  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
6090  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
6091  */
6092 __rte_experimental
6093 int rte_eth_cman_config_set(uint16_t port_id, const struct rte_eth_cman_config *config);
6094 
6095 /**
6096  * @warning
6097  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
6098  *
6099  * Retrieve the applied ethdev congestion management parameters for the given port.
6100  *
6101  * @param port_id
6102  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
6103  * @param config
6104  *   A pointer to a structure of type *rte_eth_cman_config* to retrieve
6105  *   congestion management parameters for the given object.
6106  *   Application must fill all parameters except mode_param parameter in
6107  *   struct rte_eth_cman_config.
6108  *
6109  * @return
6110  *   - (0) if successful.
6111  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if support for cman_config_get does not exist.
6112  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
6113  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
6114  */
6115 __rte_experimental
6116 int rte_eth_cman_config_get(uint16_t port_id, struct rte_eth_cman_config *config);
6117 
6118 #include <rte_ethdev_core.h>
6119 
6120 #ifdef __cplusplus
6121 extern "C" {
6122 #endif
6123 
6124 /**
6125  * @internal
6126  * Helper routine for rte_eth_rx_burst().
6127  * Should be called at exit from PMD's rte_eth_rx_bulk implementation.
6128  * Does necessary post-processing - invokes Rx callbacks if any, etc.
6129  *
6130  * @param port_id
6131  *  The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
6132  * @param queue_id
6133  *  The index of the receive queue from which to retrieve input packets.
6134  * @param rx_pkts
6135  *   The address of an array of pointers to *rte_mbuf* structures that
6136  *   have been retrieved from the device.
6137  * @param nb_rx
6138  *   The number of packets that were retrieved from the device.
6139  * @param nb_pkts
6140  *   The number of elements in @p rx_pkts array.
6141  * @param opaque
6142  *   Opaque pointer of Rx queue callback related data.
6143  *
6144  * @return
6145  *  The number of packets effectively supplied to the @p rx_pkts array.
6146  */
6147 uint16_t rte_eth_call_rx_callbacks(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id,
6148 		struct rte_mbuf **rx_pkts, uint16_t nb_rx, uint16_t nb_pkts,
6149 		void *opaque);
6150 
6151 /**
6152  *
6153  * Retrieve a burst of input packets from a receive queue of an Ethernet
6154  * device. The retrieved packets are stored in *rte_mbuf* structures whose
6155  * pointers are supplied in the *rx_pkts* array.
6156  *
6157  * The rte_eth_rx_burst() function loops, parsing the Rx ring of the
6158  * receive queue, up to *nb_pkts* packets, and for each completed Rx
6159  * descriptor in the ring, it performs the following operations:
6160  *
6161  * - Initialize the *rte_mbuf* data structure associated with the
6162  *   Rx descriptor according to the information provided by the NIC into
6163  *   that Rx descriptor.
6164  *
6165  * - Store the *rte_mbuf* data structure into the next entry of the
6166  *   *rx_pkts* array.
6167  *
6168  * - Replenish the Rx descriptor with a new *rte_mbuf* buffer
6169  *   allocated from the memory pool associated with the receive queue at
6170  *   initialization time.
6171  *
6172  * When retrieving an input packet that was scattered by the controller
6173  * into multiple receive descriptors, the rte_eth_rx_burst() function
6174  * appends the associated *rte_mbuf* buffers to the first buffer of the
6175  * packet.
6176  *
6177  * The rte_eth_rx_burst() function returns the number of packets
6178  * actually retrieved, which is the number of *rte_mbuf* data structures
6179  * effectively supplied into the *rx_pkts* array.
6180  * A return value equal to *nb_pkts* indicates that the Rx queue contained
6181  * at least *rx_pkts* packets, and this is likely to signify that other
6182  * received packets remain in the input queue. Applications implementing
6183  * a "retrieve as much received packets as possible" policy can check this
6184  * specific case and keep invoking the rte_eth_rx_burst() function until
6185  * a value less than *nb_pkts* is returned.
6186  *
6187  * This receive method has the following advantages:
6188  *
6189  * - It allows a run-to-completion network stack engine to retrieve and
6190  *   to immediately process received packets in a fast burst-oriented
6191  *   approach, avoiding the overhead of unnecessary intermediate packet
6192  *   queue/dequeue operations.
6193  *
6194  * - Conversely, it also allows an asynchronous-oriented processing
6195  *   method to retrieve bursts of received packets and to immediately
6196  *   queue them for further parallel processing by another logical core,
6197  *   for instance. However, instead of having received packets being
6198  *   individually queued by the driver, this approach allows the caller
6199  *   of the rte_eth_rx_burst() function to queue a burst of retrieved
6200  *   packets at a time and therefore dramatically reduce the cost of
6201  *   enqueue/dequeue operations per packet.
6202  *
6203  * - It allows the rte_eth_rx_burst() function of the driver to take
6204  *   advantage of burst-oriented hardware features (CPU cache,
6205  *   prefetch instructions, and so on) to minimize the number of CPU
6206  *   cycles per packet.
6207  *
6208  * To summarize, the proposed receive API enables many
6209  * burst-oriented optimizations in both synchronous and asynchronous
6210  * packet processing environments with no overhead in both cases.
6211  *
6212  * @note
6213  *   Some drivers using vector instructions require that *nb_pkts* is
6214  *   divisible by 4 or 8, depending on the driver implementation.
6215  *
6216  * The rte_eth_rx_burst() function does not provide any error
6217  * notification to avoid the corresponding overhead. As a hint, the
6218  * upper-level application might check the status of the device link once
6219  * being systematically returned a 0 value for a given number of tries.
6220  *
6221  * @param port_id
6222  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
6223  * @param queue_id
6224  *   The index of the receive queue from which to retrieve input packets.
6225  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_rx_queue - 1] previously supplied
6226  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure().
6227  * @param rx_pkts
6228  *   The address of an array of pointers to *rte_mbuf* structures that
6229  *   must be large enough to store *nb_pkts* pointers in it.
6230  * @param nb_pkts
6231  *   The maximum number of packets to retrieve.
6232  *   The value must be divisible by 8 in order to work with any driver.
6233  * @return
6234  *   The number of packets actually retrieved, which is the number
6235  *   of pointers to *rte_mbuf* structures effectively supplied to the
6236  *   *rx_pkts* array.
6237  */
6238 static inline uint16_t
6239 rte_eth_rx_burst(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id,
6240 		 struct rte_mbuf **rx_pkts, const uint16_t nb_pkts)
6241 {
6242 	uint16_t nb_rx;
6243 	struct rte_eth_fp_ops *p;
6244 	void *qd;
6245 
6246 #ifdef RTE_ETHDEV_DEBUG_RX
6247 	if (port_id >= RTE_MAX_ETHPORTS ||
6248 			queue_id >= RTE_MAX_QUEUES_PER_PORT) {
6249 		RTE_ETHDEV_LOG_LINE(ERR,
6250 			"Invalid port_id=%u or queue_id=%u",
6251 			port_id, queue_id);
6252 		return 0;
6253 	}
6254 #endif
6255 
6256 	/* fetch pointer to queue data */
6257 	p = &rte_eth_fp_ops[port_id];
6258 	qd = p->rxq.data[queue_id];
6259 
6260 #ifdef RTE_ETHDEV_DEBUG_RX
6261 	RTE_ETH_VALID_PORTID_OR_ERR_RET(port_id, 0);
6262 
6263 	if (qd == NULL) {
6264 		RTE_ETHDEV_LOG_LINE(ERR, "Invalid Rx queue_id=%u for port_id=%u",
6265 			queue_id, port_id);
6266 		return 0;
6267 	}
6268 #endif
6269 
6270 	nb_rx = p->rx_pkt_burst(qd, rx_pkts, nb_pkts);
6271 
6272 #ifdef RTE_ETHDEV_RXTX_CALLBACKS
6273 	{
6274 		void *cb;
6275 
6276 		/* rte_memory_order_release memory order was used when the
6277 		 * call back was inserted into the list.
6278 		 * Since there is a clear dependency between loading
6279 		 * cb and cb->fn/cb->next, rte_memory_order_acquire memory order is
6280 		 * not required.
6281 		 */
6282 		cb = rte_atomic_load_explicit(&p->rxq.clbk[queue_id],
6283 				rte_memory_order_relaxed);
6284 		if (unlikely(cb != NULL))
6285 			nb_rx = rte_eth_call_rx_callbacks(port_id, queue_id,
6286 					rx_pkts, nb_rx, nb_pkts, cb);
6287 	}
6288 #endif
6289 
6290 	if (unlikely(nb_rx))
6291 		rte_ethdev_trace_rx_burst_nonempty(port_id, queue_id, (void **)rx_pkts, nb_rx);
6292 	else
6293 		rte_ethdev_trace_rx_burst_empty(port_id, queue_id, (void **)rx_pkts);
6294 	return nb_rx;
6295 }
6296 
6297 /**
6298  * Get the number of used descriptors of a Rx queue
6299  *
6300  * Since it's a dataplane function, no check is performed on port_id and
6301  * queue_id. The caller must therefore ensure that the port is enabled
6302  * and the queue is configured and running.
6303  *
6304  * @param port_id
6305  *  The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
6306  * @param queue_id
6307  *  The queue ID on the specific port.
6308  * @return
6309  *  The number of used descriptors in the specific queue, or:
6310  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* is invalid.
6311  *   - (-EINVAL) if *queue_id* is invalid
6312  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if the device does not support this function
6313  */
6314 static inline int
6315 rte_eth_rx_queue_count(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id)
6316 {
6317 	struct rte_eth_fp_ops *p;
6318 	void *qd;
6319 
6320 #ifdef RTE_ETHDEV_DEBUG_RX
6321 	if (port_id >= RTE_MAX_ETHPORTS ||
6322 			queue_id >= RTE_MAX_QUEUES_PER_PORT) {
6323 		RTE_ETHDEV_LOG_LINE(ERR,
6324 			"Invalid port_id=%u or queue_id=%u",
6325 			port_id, queue_id);
6326 		return -EINVAL;
6327 	}
6328 #endif
6329 
6330 	/* fetch pointer to queue data */
6331 	p = &rte_eth_fp_ops[port_id];
6332 	qd = p->rxq.data[queue_id];
6333 
6334 #ifdef RTE_ETHDEV_DEBUG_RX
6335 	RTE_ETH_VALID_PORTID_OR_ERR_RET(port_id, -ENODEV);
6336 	if (qd == NULL)
6337 		return -EINVAL;
6338 #endif
6339 
6340 	if (*p->rx_queue_count == NULL)
6341 		return -ENOTSUP;
6342 	return (int)(*p->rx_queue_count)(qd);
6343 }
6344 
6345 /**@{@name Rx hardware descriptor states
6346  * @see rte_eth_rx_descriptor_status
6347  */
6348 #define RTE_ETH_RX_DESC_AVAIL    0 /**< Desc available for hw. */
6349 #define RTE_ETH_RX_DESC_DONE     1 /**< Desc done, filled by hw. */
6350 #define RTE_ETH_RX_DESC_UNAVAIL  2 /**< Desc used by driver or hw. */
6351 /**@}*/
6352 
6353 /**
6354  * Check the status of a Rx descriptor in the queue
6355  *
6356  * It should be called in a similar context than the Rx function:
6357  * - on a dataplane core
6358  * - not concurrently on the same queue
6359  *
6360  * Since it's a dataplane function, no check is performed on port_id and
6361  * queue_id. The caller must therefore ensure that the port is enabled
6362  * and the queue is configured and running.
6363  *
6364  * Note: accessing to a random descriptor in the ring may trigger cache
6365  * misses and have a performance impact.
6366  *
6367  * @param port_id
6368  *  A valid port identifier of the Ethernet device which.
6369  * @param queue_id
6370  *  A valid Rx queue identifier on this port.
6371  * @param offset
6372  *  The offset of the descriptor starting from tail (0 is the next
6373  *  packet to be received by the driver).
6374  *
6375  * @return
6376  *  - (RTE_ETH_RX_DESC_AVAIL): Descriptor is available for the hardware to
6377  *    receive a packet.
6378  *  - (RTE_ETH_RX_DESC_DONE): Descriptor is done, it is filled by hw, but
6379  *    not yet processed by the driver (i.e. in the receive queue).
6380  *  - (RTE_ETH_RX_DESC_UNAVAIL): Descriptor is unavailable, either hold by
6381  *    the driver and not yet returned to hw, or reserved by the hw.
6382  *  - (-EINVAL) bad descriptor offset.
6383  *  - (-ENOTSUP) if the device does not support this function.
6384  *  - (-ENODEV) bad port or queue (only if compiled with debug).
6385  */
6386 static inline int
6387 rte_eth_rx_descriptor_status(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id,
6388 	uint16_t offset)
6389 {
6390 	struct rte_eth_fp_ops *p;
6391 	void *qd;
6392 
6393 #ifdef RTE_ETHDEV_DEBUG_RX
6394 	if (port_id >= RTE_MAX_ETHPORTS ||
6395 			queue_id >= RTE_MAX_QUEUES_PER_PORT) {
6396 		RTE_ETHDEV_LOG_LINE(ERR,
6397 			"Invalid port_id=%u or queue_id=%u",
6398 			port_id, queue_id);
6399 		return -EINVAL;
6400 	}
6401 #endif
6402 
6403 	/* fetch pointer to queue data */
6404 	p = &rte_eth_fp_ops[port_id];
6405 	qd = p->rxq.data[queue_id];
6406 
6407 #ifdef RTE_ETHDEV_DEBUG_RX
6408 	RTE_ETH_VALID_PORTID_OR_ERR_RET(port_id, -ENODEV);
6409 	if (qd == NULL)
6410 		return -ENODEV;
6411 #endif
6412 	if (*p->rx_descriptor_status == NULL)
6413 		return -ENOTSUP;
6414 	return (*p->rx_descriptor_status)(qd, offset);
6415 }
6416 
6417 /**@{@name Tx hardware descriptor states
6418  * @see rte_eth_tx_descriptor_status
6419  */
6420 #define RTE_ETH_TX_DESC_FULL    0 /**< Desc filled for hw, waiting xmit. */
6421 #define RTE_ETH_TX_DESC_DONE    1 /**< Desc done, packet is transmitted. */
6422 #define RTE_ETH_TX_DESC_UNAVAIL 2 /**< Desc used by driver or hw. */
6423 /**@}*/
6424 
6425 /**
6426  * Check the status of a Tx descriptor in the queue.
6427  *
6428  * It should be called in a similar context than the Tx function:
6429  * - on a dataplane core
6430  * - not concurrently on the same queue
6431  *
6432  * Since it's a dataplane function, no check is performed on port_id and
6433  * queue_id. The caller must therefore ensure that the port is enabled
6434  * and the queue is configured and running.
6435  *
6436  * Note: accessing to a random descriptor in the ring may trigger cache
6437  * misses and have a performance impact.
6438  *
6439  * @param port_id
6440  *  A valid port identifier of the Ethernet device which.
6441  * @param queue_id
6442  *  A valid Tx queue identifier on this port.
6443  * @param offset
6444  *  The offset of the descriptor starting from tail (0 is the place where
6445  *  the next packet will be send).
6446  *
6447  * @return
6448  *  - (RTE_ETH_TX_DESC_FULL) Descriptor is being processed by the hw, i.e.
6449  *    in the transmit queue.
6450  *  - (RTE_ETH_TX_DESC_DONE) Hardware is done with this descriptor, it can
6451  *    be reused by the driver.
6452  *  - (RTE_ETH_TX_DESC_UNAVAIL): Descriptor is unavailable, reserved by the
6453  *    driver or the hardware.
6454  *  - (-EINVAL) bad descriptor offset.
6455  *  - (-ENOTSUP) if the device does not support this function.
6456  *  - (-ENODEV) bad port or queue (only if compiled with debug).
6457  */
6458 static inline int rte_eth_tx_descriptor_status(uint16_t port_id,
6459 	uint16_t queue_id, uint16_t offset)
6460 {
6461 	struct rte_eth_fp_ops *p;
6462 	void *qd;
6463 
6464 #ifdef RTE_ETHDEV_DEBUG_TX
6465 	if (port_id >= RTE_MAX_ETHPORTS ||
6466 			queue_id >= RTE_MAX_QUEUES_PER_PORT) {
6467 		RTE_ETHDEV_LOG_LINE(ERR,
6468 			"Invalid port_id=%u or queue_id=%u",
6469 			port_id, queue_id);
6470 		return -EINVAL;
6471 	}
6472 #endif
6473 
6474 	/* fetch pointer to queue data */
6475 	p = &rte_eth_fp_ops[port_id];
6476 	qd = p->txq.data[queue_id];
6477 
6478 #ifdef RTE_ETHDEV_DEBUG_TX
6479 	RTE_ETH_VALID_PORTID_OR_ERR_RET(port_id, -ENODEV);
6480 	if (qd == NULL)
6481 		return -ENODEV;
6482 #endif
6483 	if (*p->tx_descriptor_status == NULL)
6484 		return -ENOTSUP;
6485 	return (*p->tx_descriptor_status)(qd, offset);
6486 }
6487 
6488 /**
6489  * @internal
6490  * Helper routine for rte_eth_tx_burst().
6491  * Should be called before entry PMD's rte_eth_tx_bulk implementation.
6492  * Does necessary pre-processing - invokes Tx callbacks if any, etc.
6493  *
6494  * @param port_id
6495  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
6496  * @param queue_id
6497  *   The index of the transmit queue through which output packets must be
6498  *   sent.
6499  * @param tx_pkts
6500  *   The address of an array of *nb_pkts* pointers to *rte_mbuf* structures
6501  *   which contain the output packets.
6502  * @param nb_pkts
6503  *   The maximum number of packets to transmit.
6504  * @return
6505  *   The number of output packets to transmit.
6506  */
6507 uint16_t rte_eth_call_tx_callbacks(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id,
6508 	struct rte_mbuf **tx_pkts, uint16_t nb_pkts, void *opaque);
6509 
6510 /**
6511  * Send a burst of output packets on a transmit queue of an Ethernet device.
6512  *
6513  * The rte_eth_tx_burst() function is invoked to transmit output packets
6514  * on the output queue *queue_id* of the Ethernet device designated by its
6515  * *port_id*.
6516  * The *nb_pkts* parameter is the number of packets to send which are
6517  * supplied in the *tx_pkts* array of *rte_mbuf* structures, each of them
6518  * allocated from a pool created with rte_pktmbuf_pool_create().
6519  * The rte_eth_tx_burst() function loops, sending *nb_pkts* packets,
6520  * up to the number of transmit descriptors available in the Tx ring of the
6521  * transmit queue.
6522  * For each packet to send, the rte_eth_tx_burst() function performs
6523  * the following operations:
6524  *
6525  * - Pick up the next available descriptor in the transmit ring.
6526  *
6527  * - Free the network buffer previously sent with that descriptor, if any.
6528  *
6529  * - Initialize the transmit descriptor with the information provided
6530  *   in the *rte_mbuf data structure.
6531  *
6532  * In the case of a segmented packet composed of a list of *rte_mbuf* buffers,
6533  * the rte_eth_tx_burst() function uses several transmit descriptors
6534  * of the ring.
6535  *
6536  * The rte_eth_tx_burst() function returns the number of packets it
6537  * actually sent. A return value equal to *nb_pkts* means that all packets
6538  * have been sent, and this is likely to signify that other output packets
6539  * could be immediately transmitted again. Applications that implement a
6540  * "send as many packets to transmit as possible" policy can check this
6541  * specific case and keep invoking the rte_eth_tx_burst() function until
6542  * a value less than *nb_pkts* is returned.
6543  *
6544  * It is the responsibility of the rte_eth_tx_burst() function to
6545  * transparently free the memory buffers of packets previously sent.
6546  * This feature is driven by the *tx_free_thresh* value supplied to the
6547  * rte_eth_dev_configure() function at device configuration time.
6548  * When the number of free Tx descriptors drops below this threshold, the
6549  * rte_eth_tx_burst() function must [attempt to] free the *rte_mbuf*  buffers
6550  * of those packets whose transmission was effectively completed.
6551  *
6552  * If the PMD is RTE_ETH_TX_OFFLOAD_MT_LOCKFREE capable, multiple threads can
6553  * invoke this function concurrently on the same Tx queue without SW lock.
6554  * @see rte_eth_dev_info_get, struct rte_eth_txconf::offloads
6555  *
6556  * @see rte_eth_tx_prepare to perform some prior checks or adjustments
6557  * for offloads.
6558  *
6559  * @note This function must not modify mbufs (including packets data)
6560  * unless the refcnt is 1.
6561  * An exception is the bonding PMD, which does not have "Tx prepare" support,
6562  * in this case, mbufs may be modified.
6563  *
6564  * @param port_id
6565  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
6566  * @param queue_id
6567  *   The index of the transmit queue through which output packets must be
6568  *   sent.
6569  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_tx_queue - 1] previously supplied
6570  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure().
6571  * @param tx_pkts
6572  *   The address of an array of *nb_pkts* pointers to *rte_mbuf* structures
6573  *   which contain the output packets.
6574  * @param nb_pkts
6575  *   The maximum number of packets to transmit.
6576  * @return
6577  *   The number of output packets actually stored in transmit descriptors of
6578  *   the transmit ring. The return value can be less than the value of the
6579  *   *tx_pkts* parameter when the transmit ring is full or has been filled up.
6580  */
6581 static inline uint16_t
6582 rte_eth_tx_burst(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id,
6583 		 struct rte_mbuf **tx_pkts, uint16_t nb_pkts)
6584 {
6585 	struct rte_eth_fp_ops *p;
6586 	void *qd;
6587 
6588 #ifdef RTE_ETHDEV_DEBUG_TX
6589 	if (port_id >= RTE_MAX_ETHPORTS ||
6590 			queue_id >= RTE_MAX_QUEUES_PER_PORT) {
6591 		RTE_ETHDEV_LOG_LINE(ERR,
6592 			"Invalid port_id=%u or queue_id=%u",
6593 			port_id, queue_id);
6594 		return 0;
6595 	}
6596 #endif
6597 
6598 	/* fetch pointer to queue data */
6599 	p = &rte_eth_fp_ops[port_id];
6600 	qd = p->txq.data[queue_id];
6601 
6602 #ifdef RTE_ETHDEV_DEBUG_TX
6603 	RTE_ETH_VALID_PORTID_OR_ERR_RET(port_id, 0);
6604 
6605 	if (qd == NULL) {
6606 		RTE_ETHDEV_LOG_LINE(ERR, "Invalid Tx queue_id=%u for port_id=%u",
6607 			queue_id, port_id);
6608 		return 0;
6609 	}
6610 #endif
6611 
6612 #ifdef RTE_ETHDEV_RXTX_CALLBACKS
6613 	{
6614 		void *cb;
6615 
6616 		/* rte_memory_order_release memory order was used when the
6617 		 * call back was inserted into the list.
6618 		 * Since there is a clear dependency between loading
6619 		 * cb and cb->fn/cb->next, rte_memory_order_acquire memory order is
6620 		 * not required.
6621 		 */
6622 		cb = rte_atomic_load_explicit(&p->txq.clbk[queue_id],
6623 				rte_memory_order_relaxed);
6624 		if (unlikely(cb != NULL))
6625 			nb_pkts = rte_eth_call_tx_callbacks(port_id, queue_id,
6626 					tx_pkts, nb_pkts, cb);
6627 	}
6628 #endif
6629 
6630 	nb_pkts = p->tx_pkt_burst(qd, tx_pkts, nb_pkts);
6631 
6632 	rte_ethdev_trace_tx_burst(port_id, queue_id, (void **)tx_pkts, nb_pkts);
6633 	return nb_pkts;
6634 }
6635 
6636 /**
6637  * Process a burst of output packets on a transmit queue of an Ethernet device.
6638  *
6639  * The rte_eth_tx_prepare() function is invoked to prepare output packets to be
6640  * transmitted on the output queue *queue_id* of the Ethernet device designated
6641  * by its *port_id*.
6642  * The *nb_pkts* parameter is the number of packets to be prepared which are
6643  * supplied in the *tx_pkts* array of *rte_mbuf* structures, each of them
6644  * allocated from a pool created with rte_pktmbuf_pool_create().
6645  * For each packet to send, the rte_eth_tx_prepare() function performs
6646  * the following operations:
6647  *
6648  * - Check if packet meets devices requirements for Tx offloads.
6649  *
6650  * - Check limitations about number of segments.
6651  *
6652  * - Check additional requirements when debug is enabled.
6653  *
6654  * - Update and/or reset required checksums when Tx offload is set for packet.
6655  *
6656  * Since this function can modify packet data, provided mbufs must be safely
6657  * writable (e.g. modified data cannot be in shared segment).
6658  *
6659  * The rte_eth_tx_prepare() function returns the number of packets ready to be
6660  * sent. A return value equal to *nb_pkts* means that all packets are valid and
6661  * ready to be sent, otherwise stops processing on the first invalid packet and
6662  * leaves the rest packets untouched.
6663  *
6664  * When this functionality is not implemented in the driver, all packets are
6665  * are returned untouched.
6666  *
6667  * @param port_id
6668  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
6669  *   The value must be a valid port ID.
6670  * @param queue_id
6671  *   The index of the transmit queue through which output packets must be
6672  *   sent.
6673  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_tx_queue - 1] previously supplied
6674  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure().
6675  * @param tx_pkts
6676  *   The address of an array of *nb_pkts* pointers to *rte_mbuf* structures
6677  *   which contain the output packets.
6678  * @param nb_pkts
6679  *   The maximum number of packets to process.
6680  * @return
6681  *   The number of packets correct and ready to be sent. The return value can be
6682  *   less than the value of the *tx_pkts* parameter when some packet doesn't
6683  *   meet devices requirements with rte_errno set appropriately:
6684  *   - EINVAL: offload flags are not correctly set
6685  *   - ENOTSUP: the offload feature is not supported by the hardware
6686  *   - ENODEV: if *port_id* is invalid (with debug enabled only)
6687  */
6688 
6689 #ifndef RTE_ETHDEV_TX_PREPARE_NOOP
6690 
6691 static inline uint16_t
6692 rte_eth_tx_prepare(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id,
6693 		struct rte_mbuf **tx_pkts, uint16_t nb_pkts)
6694 {
6695 	struct rte_eth_fp_ops *p;
6696 	void *qd;
6697 
6698 #ifdef RTE_ETHDEV_DEBUG_TX
6699 	if (port_id >= RTE_MAX_ETHPORTS ||
6700 			queue_id >= RTE_MAX_QUEUES_PER_PORT) {
6701 		RTE_ETHDEV_LOG_LINE(ERR,
6702 			"Invalid port_id=%u or queue_id=%u",
6703 			port_id, queue_id);
6704 		rte_errno = ENODEV;
6705 		return 0;
6706 	}
6707 #endif
6708 
6709 	/* fetch pointer to queue data */
6710 	p = &rte_eth_fp_ops[port_id];
6711 	qd = p->txq.data[queue_id];
6712 
6713 #ifdef RTE_ETHDEV_DEBUG_TX
6714 	if (!rte_eth_dev_is_valid_port(port_id)) {
6715 		RTE_ETHDEV_LOG_LINE(ERR, "Invalid Tx port_id=%u", port_id);
6716 		rte_errno = ENODEV;
6717 		return 0;
6718 	}
6719 	if (qd == NULL) {
6720 		RTE_ETHDEV_LOG_LINE(ERR, "Invalid Tx queue_id=%u for port_id=%u",
6721 			queue_id, port_id);
6722 		rte_errno = EINVAL;
6723 		return 0;
6724 	}
6725 #endif
6726 
6727 	if (!p->tx_pkt_prepare)
6728 		return nb_pkts;
6729 
6730 	return p->tx_pkt_prepare(qd, tx_pkts, nb_pkts);
6731 }
6732 
6733 #else
6734 
6735 /*
6736  * Native NOOP operation for compilation targets which doesn't require any
6737  * preparations steps, and functional NOOP may introduce unnecessary performance
6738  * drop.
6739  *
6740  * Generally this is not a good idea to turn it on globally and didn't should
6741  * be used if behavior of tx_preparation can change.
6742  */
6743 
6744 static inline uint16_t
6745 rte_eth_tx_prepare(__rte_unused uint16_t port_id,
6746 		__rte_unused uint16_t queue_id,
6747 		__rte_unused struct rte_mbuf **tx_pkts, uint16_t nb_pkts)
6748 {
6749 	return nb_pkts;
6750 }
6751 
6752 #endif
6753 
6754 /**
6755  * Send any packets queued up for transmission on a port and HW queue
6756  *
6757  * This causes an explicit flush of packets previously buffered via the
6758  * rte_eth_tx_buffer() function. It returns the number of packets successfully
6759  * sent to the NIC, and calls the error callback for any unsent packets. Unless
6760  * explicitly set up otherwise, the default callback simply frees the unsent
6761  * packets back to the owning mempool.
6762  *
6763  * @param port_id
6764  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
6765  * @param queue_id
6766  *   The index of the transmit queue through which output packets must be
6767  *   sent.
6768  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_tx_queue - 1] previously supplied
6769  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure().
6770  * @param buffer
6771  *   Buffer of packets to be transmit.
6772  * @return
6773  *   The number of packets successfully sent to the Ethernet device. The error
6774  *   callback is called for any packets which could not be sent.
6775  */
6776 static inline uint16_t
6777 rte_eth_tx_buffer_flush(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id,
6778 		struct rte_eth_dev_tx_buffer *buffer)
6779 {
6780 	uint16_t sent;
6781 	uint16_t to_send = buffer->length;
6782 
6783 	if (to_send == 0)
6784 		return 0;
6785 
6786 	sent = rte_eth_tx_burst(port_id, queue_id, buffer->pkts, to_send);
6787 
6788 	buffer->length = 0;
6789 
6790 	/* All packets sent, or to be dealt with by callback below */
6791 	if (unlikely(sent != to_send))
6792 		buffer->error_callback(&buffer->pkts[sent],
6793 				       (uint16_t)(to_send - sent),
6794 				       buffer->error_userdata);
6795 
6796 	return sent;
6797 }
6798 
6799 /**
6800  * Buffer a single packet for future transmission on a port and queue
6801  *
6802  * This function takes a single mbuf/packet and buffers it for later
6803  * transmission on the particular port and queue specified. Once the buffer is
6804  * full of packets, an attempt will be made to transmit all the buffered
6805  * packets. In case of error, where not all packets can be transmitted, a
6806  * callback is called with the unsent packets as a parameter. If no callback
6807  * is explicitly set up, the unsent packets are just freed back to the owning
6808  * mempool. The function returns the number of packets actually sent i.e.
6809  * 0 if no buffer flush occurred, otherwise the number of packets successfully
6810  * flushed
6811  *
6812  * @param port_id
6813  *   The port identifier of the Ethernet device.
6814  * @param queue_id
6815  *   The index of the transmit queue through which output packets must be
6816  *   sent.
6817  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_tx_queue - 1] previously supplied
6818  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure().
6819  * @param buffer
6820  *   Buffer used to collect packets to be sent.
6821  * @param tx_pkt
6822  *   Pointer to the packet mbuf to be sent.
6823  * @return
6824  *   0 = packet has been buffered for later transmission
6825  *   N > 0 = packet has been buffered, and the buffer was subsequently flushed,
6826  *     causing N packets to be sent, and the error callback to be called for
6827  *     the rest.
6828  */
6829 static __rte_always_inline uint16_t
6830 rte_eth_tx_buffer(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id,
6831 		struct rte_eth_dev_tx_buffer *buffer, struct rte_mbuf *tx_pkt)
6832 {
6833 	buffer->pkts[buffer->length++] = tx_pkt;
6834 	if (buffer->length < buffer->size)
6835 		return 0;
6836 
6837 	return rte_eth_tx_buffer_flush(port_id, queue_id, buffer);
6838 }
6839 
6840 /**
6841  * @warning
6842  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice
6843  *
6844  * Recycle used mbufs from a transmit queue of an Ethernet device, and move
6845  * these mbufs into a mbuf ring for a receive queue of an Ethernet device.
6846  * This can bypass mempool path to save CPU cycles.
6847  *
6848  * The rte_eth_recycle_mbufs() function loops, with rte_eth_rx_burst() and
6849  * rte_eth_tx_burst() functions, freeing Tx used mbufs and replenishing Rx
6850  * descriptors. The number of recycling mbufs depends on the request of Rx mbuf
6851  * ring, with the constraint of enough used mbufs from Tx mbuf ring.
6852  *
6853  * For each recycling mbufs, the rte_eth_recycle_mbufs() function performs the
6854  * following operations:
6855  *
6856  * - Copy used *rte_mbuf* buffer pointers from Tx mbuf ring into Rx mbuf ring.
6857  *
6858  * - Replenish the Rx descriptors with the recycling *rte_mbuf* mbufs freed
6859  *   from the Tx mbuf ring.
6860  *
6861  * This function spilts Rx and Tx path with different callback functions. The
6862  * callback function recycle_tx_mbufs_reuse is for Tx driver. The callback
6863  * function recycle_rx_descriptors_refill is for Rx driver. rte_eth_recycle_mbufs()
6864  * can support the case that Rx Ethernet device is different from Tx Ethernet device.
6865  *
6866  * It is the responsibility of users to select the Rx/Tx queue pair to recycle
6867  * mbufs. Before call this function, users must call rte_eth_recycle_rxq_info_get
6868  * function to retrieve selected Rx queue information.
6869  * @see rte_eth_recycle_rxq_info_get, struct rte_eth_recycle_rxq_info
6870  *
6871  * Currently, the rte_eth_recycle_mbufs() function can support to feed 1 Rx queue from
6872  * 2 Tx queues in the same thread. Do not pair the Rx queue and Tx queue in different
6873  * threads, in order to avoid memory error rewriting.
6874  *
6875  * @param rx_port_id
6876  *   Port identifying the receive side.
6877  * @param rx_queue_id
6878  *   The index of the receive queue identifying the receive side.
6879  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_rx_queue - 1] previously supplied
6880  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure().
6881  * @param tx_port_id
6882  *   Port identifying the transmit side.
6883  * @param tx_queue_id
6884  *   The index of the transmit queue identifying the transmit side.
6885  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_tx_queue - 1] previously supplied
6886  *   to rte_eth_dev_configure().
6887  * @param recycle_rxq_info
6888  *   A pointer to a structure of type *rte_eth_recycle_rxq_info* which contains
6889  *   the information of the Rx queue mbuf ring.
6890  * @return
6891  *   The number of recycling mbufs.
6892  */
6893 __rte_experimental
6894 static inline uint16_t
6895 rte_eth_recycle_mbufs(uint16_t rx_port_id, uint16_t rx_queue_id,
6896 		uint16_t tx_port_id, uint16_t tx_queue_id,
6897 		struct rte_eth_recycle_rxq_info *recycle_rxq_info)
6898 {
6899 	struct rte_eth_fp_ops *p1, *p2;
6900 	void *qd1, *qd2;
6901 	uint16_t nb_mbufs;
6902 
6903 #ifdef RTE_ETHDEV_DEBUG_TX
6904 	if (tx_port_id >= RTE_MAX_ETHPORTS ||
6905 			tx_queue_id >= RTE_MAX_QUEUES_PER_PORT) {
6906 		RTE_ETHDEV_LOG_LINE(ERR,
6907 				"Invalid tx_port_id=%u or tx_queue_id=%u",
6908 				tx_port_id, tx_queue_id);
6909 		return 0;
6910 	}
6911 #endif
6912 
6913 	/* fetch pointer to Tx queue data */
6914 	p1 = &rte_eth_fp_ops[tx_port_id];
6915 	qd1 = p1->txq.data[tx_queue_id];
6916 
6917 #ifdef RTE_ETHDEV_DEBUG_TX
6918 	RTE_ETH_VALID_PORTID_OR_ERR_RET(tx_port_id, 0);
6919 
6920 	if (qd1 == NULL) {
6921 		RTE_ETHDEV_LOG_LINE(ERR, "Invalid Tx queue_id=%u for port_id=%u",
6922 				tx_queue_id, tx_port_id);
6923 		return 0;
6924 	}
6925 #endif
6926 	if (p1->recycle_tx_mbufs_reuse == NULL)
6927 		return 0;
6928 
6929 #ifdef RTE_ETHDEV_DEBUG_RX
6930 	if (rx_port_id >= RTE_MAX_ETHPORTS ||
6931 			rx_queue_id >= RTE_MAX_QUEUES_PER_PORT) {
6932 		RTE_ETHDEV_LOG_LINE(ERR, "Invalid rx_port_id=%u or rx_queue_id=%u",
6933 				rx_port_id, rx_queue_id);
6934 		return 0;
6935 	}
6936 #endif
6937 
6938 	/* fetch pointer to Rx queue data */
6939 	p2 = &rte_eth_fp_ops[rx_port_id];
6940 	qd2 = p2->rxq.data[rx_queue_id];
6941 
6942 #ifdef RTE_ETHDEV_DEBUG_RX
6943 	RTE_ETH_VALID_PORTID_OR_ERR_RET(rx_port_id, 0);
6944 
6945 	if (qd2 == NULL) {
6946 		RTE_ETHDEV_LOG_LINE(ERR, "Invalid Rx queue_id=%u for port_id=%u",
6947 				rx_queue_id, rx_port_id);
6948 		return 0;
6949 	}
6950 #endif
6951 	if (p2->recycle_rx_descriptors_refill == NULL)
6952 		return 0;
6953 
6954 	/* Copy used *rte_mbuf* buffer pointers from Tx mbuf ring
6955 	 * into Rx mbuf ring.
6956 	 */
6957 	nb_mbufs = p1->recycle_tx_mbufs_reuse(qd1, recycle_rxq_info);
6958 
6959 	/* If no recycling mbufs, return 0. */
6960 	if (nb_mbufs == 0)
6961 		return 0;
6962 
6963 	/* Replenish the Rx descriptors with the recycling
6964 	 * into Rx mbuf ring.
6965 	 */
6966 	p2->recycle_rx_descriptors_refill(qd2, nb_mbufs);
6967 
6968 	return nb_mbufs;
6969 }
6970 
6971 /**
6972  * @warning
6973  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change without prior notice
6974  *
6975  * Get supported header protocols to split on Rx.
6976  *
6977  * When a packet type is announced to be split,
6978  * it *must* be supported by the PMD.
6979  * For instance, if eth-ipv4, eth-ipv4-udp is announced,
6980  * the PMD must return the following packet types for these packets:
6981  * - Ether/IPv4             -> RTE_PTYPE_L2_ETHER | RTE_PTYPE_L3_IPV4
6982  * - Ether/IPv4/UDP         -> RTE_PTYPE_L2_ETHER | RTE_PTYPE_L3_IPV4 | RTE_PTYPE_L4_UDP
6983  *
6984  * @param port_id
6985  *   The port identifier of the device.
6986  * @param[out] ptypes
6987  *   An array pointer to store supported protocol headers, allocated by caller.
6988  *   These ptypes are composed with RTE_PTYPE_*.
6989  * @param num
6990  *   Size of the array pointed by param ptypes.
6991  * @return
6992  *   - (>=0) Number of supported ptypes. If the number of types exceeds num,
6993  *           only num entries will be filled into the ptypes array,
6994  *           but the full count of supported ptypes will be returned.
6995  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if header protocol is not supported by device.
6996  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* invalid.
6997  *   - (-EINVAL) if bad parameter.
6998  */
6999 __rte_experimental
7000 int rte_eth_buffer_split_get_supported_hdr_ptypes(uint16_t port_id, uint32_t *ptypes, int num);
7001 
7002 /**
7003  * @warning
7004  * @b EXPERIMENTAL: this API may change, or be removed, without prior notice.
7005  *
7006  * Get the number of used descriptors of a Tx queue.
7007  *
7008  * This function retrieves the number of used descriptors of a transmit queue.
7009  * Applications can use this API in the fast path to inspect Tx queue occupancy
7010  * and take appropriate actions based on the available free descriptors.
7011  * An example action could be implementing Random Early Discard (RED).
7012  *
7013  * Since it's a fast-path function, no check is performed on port_id and queue_id.
7014  * The caller must therefore ensure that the port is enabled
7015  * and the queue is configured and running.
7016  *
7017  * @param port_id
7018  *   The port identifier of the device.
7019  * @param queue_id
7020  *   The index of the transmit queue.
7021  *   The value must be in the range [0, nb_tx_queue - 1]
7022  *   previously supplied to rte_eth_dev_configure().
7023  * @return
7024  *   The number of used descriptors in the specific queue, or:
7025  *   - (-ENODEV) if *port_id* is invalid. Enabled only when RTE_ETHDEV_DEBUG_TX is enabled.
7026  *   - (-EINVAL) if *queue_id* is invalid. Enabled only when RTE_ETHDEV_DEBUG_TX is enabled.
7027  *   - (-ENOTSUP) if the device does not support this function.
7028  *
7029  * @note This function is designed for fast-path use.
7030  * @note There is no requirement to call this function before rte_eth_tx_burst() invocation.
7031  * @note Utilize this function exclusively when the caller needs to determine
7032  * the used queue count across all descriptors of a Tx queue.
7033  * If the use case only involves checking the status of a specific descriptor slot,
7034  * opt for rte_eth_tx_descriptor_status() instead.
7035  */
7036 __rte_experimental
7037 static inline int
7038 rte_eth_tx_queue_count(uint16_t port_id, uint16_t queue_id)
7039 {
7040 	struct rte_eth_fp_ops *fops;
7041 	void *qd;
7042 	int rc;
7043 
7044 #ifdef RTE_ETHDEV_DEBUG_TX
7045 	if (port_id >= RTE_MAX_ETHPORTS || !rte_eth_dev_is_valid_port(port_id)) {
7046 		RTE_ETHDEV_LOG_LINE(ERR, "Invalid port_id=%u", port_id);
7047 		rc = -ENODEV;
7048 		goto out;
7049 	}
7050 
7051 	if (queue_id >= RTE_MAX_QUEUES_PER_PORT) {
7052 		RTE_ETHDEV_LOG_LINE(ERR, "Invalid queue_id=%u for port_id=%u",
7053 				    queue_id, port_id);
7054 		rc = -EINVAL;
7055 		goto out;
7056 	}
7057 #endif
7058 
7059 	/* Fetch pointer to Tx queue data */
7060 	fops = &rte_eth_fp_ops[port_id];
7061 	qd = fops->txq.data[queue_id];
7062 
7063 #ifdef RTE_ETHDEV_DEBUG_TX
7064 	if (qd == NULL) {
7065 		RTE_ETHDEV_LOG_LINE(ERR, "Invalid queue_id=%u for port_id=%u",
7066 				    queue_id, port_id);
7067 		rc = -EINVAL;
7068 		goto out;
7069 	}
7070 #endif
7071 	if (fops->tx_queue_count == NULL) {
7072 		rc = -ENOTSUP;
7073 		goto out;
7074 	}
7075 
7076 	rc = fops->tx_queue_count(qd);
7077 
7078 out:
7079 	rte_eth_trace_tx_queue_count(port_id, queue_id, rc);
7080 	return rc;
7081 }
7082 
7083 #ifdef __cplusplus
7084 }
7085 #endif
7086 
7087 #endif /* _RTE_ETHDEV_H_ */
7088